]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
Fix signedness comparison warning in elfcore_grok_win32pstatus()
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
b3adc24a 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
b3adc24a 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
b3adc24a 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129@ifset GENERIC
130* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
131@end ifset
132@ifclear GENERIC
133@ifset H8300
134* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
135@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
136@ifset Renesas
137* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 138@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
139@ifset ARM
140* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
141@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
142@ifset M68HC11
143* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
144@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
145@ifset HPPA
146* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
147@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
148@ifset M68K
149* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
150@end ifset
833794fc
MR
151@ifset MIPS
152* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
153@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
154@ifset POWERPC
155* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
156@end ifset
157@ifset POWERPC64
158* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
159@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
160@ifset S/390
161* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
162@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
163@ifset SPU
164* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
165@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
166@ifset TICOFF
167* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
168@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
169@ifset WIN32
170* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
171@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
172@ifset XTENSA
173* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
174@end ifset
252b5132
RH
175@end ifclear
176@ifclear SingleFormat
177* BFD:: BFD
178@end ifclear
179@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
180
181* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
182* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 183* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 184* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 185@end menu
84ec0e6d 186@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
187
188@node Overview
189@chapter Overview
190
191@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
192@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 193
0879a67a 194@ifset man
0285c67d 195@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 196ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
197@c man end
198
199@c man begin SEEALSO
200ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
201the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
202@file{ld}.
203@c man end
204@end ifset
205
206@c man begin DESCRIPTION
207
ff5dcc92 208@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 209their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 210compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 211
ff5dcc92 212@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
213a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
214to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
215
0285c67d
NC
216@ifset man
217@c For the man only
ece2d90e 218This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
219@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
220language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
221@end ifset
222
252b5132 223@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
224This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
225to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
226write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
227@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
228available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
229@end ifclear
230
231Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
232linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
233execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 234@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
235(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
236
0285c67d
NC
237@c man end
238
252b5132
RH
239@node Invocation
240@chapter Invocation
241
0285c67d
NC
242@c man begin DESCRIPTION
243
ff5dcc92 244The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
245and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
246you have many choices to control its behavior.
247
0285c67d
NC
248@c man end
249
252b5132
RH
250@ifset UsesEnvVars
251@menu
a05a5b64 252* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
253* Environment:: Environment Variables
254@end menu
255
256@node Options
a05a5b64 257@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
258@end ifset
259
260@cindex command line
261@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
262
263@c man begin OPTIONS
264
252b5132
RH
265The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
266practice few of them are used in any particular context.
267@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 268For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
269object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
270link a file @code{hello.o}:
271
272@smallexample
273ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
274@end smallexample
275
ff5dcc92 276This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
277result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
278the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
279directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
280
ff5dcc92 281Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
282point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
283as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
284which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
285files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
286different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
287occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
288option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
289noted in the descriptions below.
290
291@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
292Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
293together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
294options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
295an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
296
297Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
298specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
299and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
300are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
301message @samp{No input files}.
302
36f63dca 303If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
304assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
305augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
306linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
307permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
308or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
309@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
310script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
311extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
312to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
313the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
314
315For options whose names are a single letter,
316option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
317whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
318option that requires them.
319
320For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 321precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 322@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 323this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 324only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
325@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
326name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
327output.
328
329Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
330option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
331immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
332@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
333Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
334accepted.
252b5132 335
36f63dca 336Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 337(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
338prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
339compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
340
341@smallexample
2509a395 342 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
343@end smallexample
344
345This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
346silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
347may also arise when passing options that require values through a
348driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
349a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
350and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
351the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
352
353@smallexample
354 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
355@end smallexample
4e53152f 356
a05a5b64 357Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
358linker:
359
ff5dcc92 360@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 361@include at-file.texi
dff70155 362
2509a395
SL
363@kindex -a @var{keyword}
364@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
365This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
366argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
367@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
368@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
369to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
370
7ee314fa
AM
371@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
372@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
374@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
375specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
376will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
377finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 378it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 379This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 380interface.
7ee314fa 381
252b5132
RH
382@ifclear SingleFormat
383@cindex binary input format
384@kindex -b @var{format}
385@kindex --format=@var{format}
386@cindex input format
387@cindex input format
388@item -b @var{input-format}
389@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
390@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
391file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 392@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 393that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 394configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 395to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
396default input format the most usual format on each machine.
397@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
398supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
399formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
400@xref{BFD}.
401
402You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
403binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
404linking object files of different formats), by including
405@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 406particular format.
252b5132
RH
407
408The default format is taken from the environment variable
409@code{GNUTARGET}.
410@ifset UsesEnvVars
411@xref{Environment}.
412@end ifset
413You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
414@code{TARGET};
415@ifclear man
416see @ref{Format Commands}.
417@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
418@end ifclear
419
420@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
421@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@cindex compatibility, MRI
423@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
424@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 425For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 426files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
427@ifclear man
428@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
429@end ifclear
430@ifset man
431the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
432@end ifset
433Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 434the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
435scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
436If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
437specified by any @samp{-L} options.
438
439@cindex common allocation
440@kindex -d
441@kindex -dc
442@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 443@item -d
252b5132
RH
444@itemx -dc
445@itemx -dp
446These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
447compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
448even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
449script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
450@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
451
7ee314fa
AM
452@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
453@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
454@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
455@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
456Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
457@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
458specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
459will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
460option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 461The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 462
abf874aa
CL
463@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
464@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
466fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
467section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
468error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
469several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
470section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
471sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
472
473@smallexample
474 MEMORY @{
475 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
476 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
477 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 @}
479 SECTIONS @{
480 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
481 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
482 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 @}
484
485 with input sections:
486 .data.1: size 8
487 .data.2: size 0x10
488 .data.3: size 4
489
490 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
491 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
492@end smallexample
493
494This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
495the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
496
497@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
498@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499This option enables warnings when
500@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
501matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
502discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
503output region.
504
252b5132
RH
505@cindex entry point, from command line
506@kindex -e @var{entry}
507@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 508@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
509@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
510Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
511program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
512named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
513and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
514base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
515@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
516and other ways of specifying the entry point.
517
b58f81ae
DJ
518@kindex --exclude-libs
519@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
520Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 521exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
522@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
523automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
524port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
525explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
526option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
527be treated as hidden.
528
e1c37eb5
DK
529@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
530@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
531Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
532should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
533into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
534may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
535used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
536the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
537match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
538command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
539of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
540regardless of this option.
541
252b5132
RH
542@cindex dynamic symbol table
543@kindex -E
544@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 545@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
546@item -E
547@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
548@itemx --no-export-dynamic
549When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
550option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
551all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
552set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
553
554If you do not use either of these options (or use the
555@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
556dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
557referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
558
559If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
560back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
561dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
562linking the program itself.
563
55255dae 564You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 565be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 566See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 567
8b747e1a
DK
568Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
569support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
570the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
571
37a141bf
FS
572@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
573@cindex export dynamic symbol
574@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
575When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
576@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
577shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
578bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
579no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
580@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
581on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
582
583@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
584@cindex export dynamic symbol list
585@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
586Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
587The format of the file is the same as the version node without
588scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
589
36f63dca 590@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
591@cindex big-endian objects
592@cindex endianness
593@kindex -EB
594@item -EB
595Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
596
597@cindex little-endian objects
598@kindex -EL
599@item -EL
600Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 601@end ifclear
252b5132 602
2509a395
SL
603@kindex -f @var{name}
604@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
605@item -f @var{name}
606@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
607When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
608to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
609table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
610symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
611
612If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
613run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
614the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
615first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
616@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
617in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
618Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
619implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 620machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
621
622This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
623will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
624
2509a395
SL
625@kindex -F @var{name}
626@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 627@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 628@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
629When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
630the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
631of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
632on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
633
634If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
635run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
636dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
637filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
638found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
639used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
640@var{name}.
641
ff5dcc92 642Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 643toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
644object files.
645@ifclear SingleFormat
646The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 647@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 648@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
649environment variable.
650@end ifclear
651The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
652creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 653
3dbf70a2 654@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
655@kindex -fini=@var{name}
656@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
657When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
658executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
659address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
660the function to call.
661
252b5132
RH
662@kindex -g
663@item -g
664Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
665
2509a395
SL
666@kindex -G @var{value}
667@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 668@cindex object size
2509a395 669@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
670@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
671Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
672@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 673MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
674sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
675
676@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 677@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 678@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 679@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
680@itemx -soname=@var{name}
681When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
682the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
683which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
684linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
685field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
686
687@kindex -i
688@cindex incremental link
689@item -i
690Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
691
3dbf70a2 692@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
693@kindex -init=@var{name}
694@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
695When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
696executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
697of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
698function to call.
699
252b5132 700@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 701@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 702@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 703@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
704@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
705Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
706list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
707If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 708will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 709will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 710
ff5dcc92 711On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
712files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
713and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
714called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
715@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
716indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
717to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
718@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
719
720The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
721specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
722was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
723command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
724archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
725the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
726
ff5dcc92 727See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
728archives multiple times.
729
730You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
731
732@ifset GENERIC
733This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 734if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
735behaviour of the AIX linker.
736@end ifset
737
738@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 739@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 740@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 741@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 742@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
743Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
744for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
745option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
746in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
747on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 748@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
749order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
750how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
751option is specified.
252b5132 752
3aa2d05a
NC
753If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
754prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
755@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 756
252b5132
RH
757@ifset UsesEnvVars
758The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 759@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
760some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
761@end ifset
762
763The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
764@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
765at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
766
767@cindex emulation
768@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 769@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
770Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
771emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
772
773If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
774@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
775
776Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
777configured.
778
779@cindex link map
780@kindex -M
781@kindex --print-map
782@item -M
783@itemx --print-map
784Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
785information about the link, including the following:
786
787@itemize @bullet
788@item
3b83e13a 789Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
790@item
791How common symbols are allocated.
792@item
793All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
794which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
795@item
796The values assigned to symbols.
797
798Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
799involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
800have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
801linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
802of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
803the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
804linker script containing:
805
806@smallexample
807 foo = 1
808 foo = foo * 4
809 foo = foo + 8
810@end smallexample
811
812will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
813option is used:
814
815@smallexample
816 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
817 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
819@end smallexample
820
821See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
822scripts.
d2ef37eb 823
06ddcada
AM
824@item
825How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 826
06ddcada
AM
827When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
828.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
829These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
830
831@smallexample
832Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
833@end smallexample
834
06ddcada 835This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
836merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
837is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
838
839@smallexample
06ddcada 840Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
841@end smallexample
842
06ddcada 843This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
844when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
845is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
846@end itemize
847
035801ce
FS
848@cindex link map discarded
849@kindex --print-map-discarded
850@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
851@item --print-map-discarded
852@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
853Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
854in the link map. Enabled by default.
855
252b5132
RH
856@kindex -n
857@cindex read-only text
858@cindex NMAGIC
859@kindex --nmagic
860@item -n
861@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
862Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
863libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
864mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
865
866@kindex -N
867@kindex --omagic
868@cindex read/write from cmd line
869@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 870@item -N
252b5132
RH
871@itemx --omagic
872Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
873not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
874libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
875mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
876is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
877specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
878
879@kindex --no-omagic
880@cindex OMAGIC
881@item --no-omagic
882This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
883sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
884be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
885shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
886
887@kindex -o @var{output}
888@kindex --output=@var{output}
889@cindex naming the output file
890@item -o @var{output}
891@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 892Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
893option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
894script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
895
f37b21b4
RM
896@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
897@cindex dependency file
898@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
899Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
900suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
901that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
902output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
903Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
904Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
905to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
906linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
907@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
908installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
909distributed makefiles without careful editing.
910
252b5132
RH
911@kindex -O @var{level}
912@cindex generating optimized output
913@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 914If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 915the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
916should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
917option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
918the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
919no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
920of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 921
387dd777
DP
922@kindex -plugin @var{name}
923@item -plugin @var{name}
924Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
925the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
926automatically added by the complier, when using link time
927optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
928wish.
929
930Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
931from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
932@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
933those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 934copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 935based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 936just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 937
26278bb8
UD
938@kindex --push-state
939@cindex push state governing input file handling
940@item --push-state
941The @option{--push-state} allows to preserve the current state of the
942flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
943restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
944
945The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
946@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
947@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
948@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
949@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
950@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
951
952One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
953used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
954listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
955something as follows:
956
957@smallexample
958-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
959@end smallexample
960
961@kindex --pop-state
962@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 963@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
964Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
965flags governing input file handling.
966
a712da20
NC
967@kindex -q
968@kindex --emit-relocs
969@cindex retain relocations in final executable
970@item -q
971@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 972Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
973Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
974order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
975in larger executables.
976
dbab7a7b
NC
977This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
978
4f471f39
RS
979@kindex --force-dynamic
980@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
981@item --force-dynamic
982Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
983to VxWorks targets.
984
252b5132
RH
985@cindex partial link
986@cindex relocatable output
987@kindex -r
1049f94e 988@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 989@item -r
1049f94e 990@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 991Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 992turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
993linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
994magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
995@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 996@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
997If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
998linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
999constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1000
62bf86b4
HPN
1001When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1002partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1003relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1004example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1005with input files in other formats at all.
1006
252b5132
RH
1007This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1008
1009@kindex -R @var{file}
1010@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1011@cindex symbol-only input
1012@item -R @var{filename}
1013@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1014Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1015relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1016to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1017programs. You may use this option more than once.
1018
ff5dcc92 1019For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1020followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1021the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1022
1023@kindex -s
1024@kindex --strip-all
1025@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1026@item -s
252b5132
RH
1027@itemx --strip-all
1028Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1029
1030@kindex -S
1031@kindex --strip-debug
1032@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1033@item -S
252b5132
RH
1034@itemx --strip-debug
1035Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1036
a70f34c0
NC
1037@kindex --strip-discarded
1038@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1039@item --strip-discarded
1040@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1041Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1042Enabled by default.
1043
252b5132
RH
1044@kindex -t
1045@kindex --trace
1046@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1047@item -t
252b5132 1048@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1049Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1050@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1051@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1052and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1053a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1054
1055@kindex -T @var{script}
1056@kindex --script=@var{script}
1057@cindex script files
1058@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1059@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1060Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1061@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1062@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1063output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1064the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1065specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1066options accumulate.
252b5132 1067
14be8564
L
1068@kindex -dT @var{script}
1069@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1070@cindex script files
1071@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1072@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1073Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1074
1075This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1076processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1077command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1078@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1079behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1080command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1081the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1082@samp{gcc}).
1083
252b5132
RH
1084@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1085@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1086@cindex undefined symbol
1087@item -u @var{symbol}
1088@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1089Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1090symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1091modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1092different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1093option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1094
0a618243
AB
1095If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1096into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1097undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1098instead.
1099
1100@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1101@cindex symbols, require defined
1102@cindex defined symbol
1103@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1104Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1105is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1106is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1107and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1108@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1109can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1110
252b5132
RH
1111@kindex -Ur
1112@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1113@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1114For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1115@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1116turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1117@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1118It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1119with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1120be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1121@samp{-r} for the others.
1122
c005eb9e
AB
1123@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1124@cindex orphan sections
1125@cindex sections, orphan
1126@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1127Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1128specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1129
1130@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1131
1132@table @code
1133@item place
1134Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1135the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1136@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1137
1138@item discard
1139All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1140@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1141
1142@item warn
1143The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1144issue a warning.
1145
1146@item error
1147The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1148@end table
1149
1150The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1151
577a0623
AM
1152@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1153@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1155@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1156missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1157specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1158multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1159input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1160in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1161
252b5132
RH
1162@kindex -v
1163@kindex -V
1164@kindex --version
1165@cindex version
1166@item -v
1167@itemx --version
1168@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1169Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1170lists the supported emulations.
1171
1172@kindex -x
1173@kindex --discard-all
1174@cindex deleting local symbols
1175@item -x
1176@itemx --discard-all
1177Delete all local symbols.
1178
1179@kindex -X
1180@kindex --discard-locals
1181@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1182@item -X
252b5132 1183@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1184Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1185system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1186or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1187
1188@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1189@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1190@cindex symbol tracing
1191@item -y @var{symbol}
1192@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1193Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1194option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1195to prepend an underscore.
1196
1197This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1198don't know where the reference is coming from.
1199
1200@kindex -Y @var{path}
1201@item -Y @var{path}
1202Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1203for Solaris compatibility.
1204
1205@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1206@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1207The recognized keywords are:
1208@table @samp
1209
e6e2dfbd
AM
1210@item bndplt
1211Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1212
1213@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1214@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1215@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1216@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1217Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1218to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1219@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1220@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1221@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1222@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1223Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1224
233a0083
L
1225@item cet-report=none
1226@itemx cet-report=warning
1227@itemx cet-report=error
1228Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1229GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1230section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1231linker not report missing properties in input files.
1232@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1233missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1234the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1235Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1236GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1237turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1238Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1239
cd6d6c15 1240@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1241@itemx nocombreloc
1242Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1243dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1244
b8871f35 1245@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1246@itemx nocommon
1247Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1248link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1249
1250@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1251Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1252layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1253using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1254
cd6d6c15 1255@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1256Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1257is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1258This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1259
e6e2dfbd
AM
1260@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1261@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1262Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1263if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1264by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1265@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1266may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1267selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1268these options.
1269
6aa29e7b
JJ
1270@item execstack
1271Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1272
b039ef04
L
1273@item global
1274This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1275the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1276of subsequently loaded libraries.
1277
93ab9c0d
NC
1278@item globalaudit
1279This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1280This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1281setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1282tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1283the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1284all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1285
e6e2dfbd
AM
1286@item ibtplt
1287Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1288Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1289
8df93cb5 1290@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1291Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1292to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1293Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1294
cd6d6c15
NC
1295@item initfirst
1296This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1297It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1298before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1299the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1300the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1301objects.
1302
1303@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1304Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1305so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1306libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1307
5fa222e4
AM
1308@item lazy
1309When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1310dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1311the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1312Lazy binding is the default.
1313
cd6d6c15 1314@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1315Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1316
e6e2dfbd
AM
1317@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1318Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1319
e6e2dfbd
AM
1320@item muldefs
1321Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1322
cd6d6c15 1323@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1324Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1325defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1326
1327@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1328Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1329should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1330
1331@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1332Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1333
1334@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1335Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1336
1337@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1338Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1339
6aa29e7b
JJ
1340@item noexecstack
1341Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1342
e6e2dfbd
AM
1343@item noextern-protected-data
1344Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1345library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1346used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1347generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1348module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1349i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1350
e6e2dfbd
AM
1351@item noreloc-overflow
1352Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1353relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1354overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1355
cd6d6c15
NC
1356@item now
1357When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1358dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1359when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1360function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1361called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1362
1363@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1364Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1365
6aa29e7b 1366@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1367@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1368Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1369specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1370relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1371than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1372Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1373
47acac12
L
1374@item separate-code
1375@itemx noseparate-code
1376Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1377specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1378be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1379code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1380
e6e2dfbd
AM
1381@item shstk
1382Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1383to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1384Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1385
04c3a755 1386@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1387Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1388Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1389@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1390
cae64165
RM
1391@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1392@cindex visibility
1393@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1394Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1395@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1396Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1397@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1398start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1399compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1400recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1401programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1402between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1403
e6e2dfbd
AM
1404@item text
1405@itemx notext
1406@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1407Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1408or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1409report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1410
97a232d7
NC
1411@item undefs
1412Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1413either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1414This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1415
cd6d6c15
NC
1416@end table
1417
ece2d90e 1418Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1419
1420@kindex -(
1421@cindex groups of archives
1422@item -( @var{archives} -)
1423@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1424The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1425either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1426
1427The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1428references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1429the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1430archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1431object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1432would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1433they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1434resolved.
1435
1436Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1437it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1438more archives.
1439
69da35b5
NC
1440@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1441@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1442@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1443@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1444Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1445recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1446and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1447the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1448behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1449so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1450restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1451
4a43e768
AM
1452@kindex --as-needed
1453@kindex --no-as-needed
1454@item --as-needed
1455@itemx --no-as-needed
1456This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1457on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1458the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1459on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1460needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1461emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1462non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1463the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1464non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1465Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1466the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1467needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1468from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1469
e56f61be
L
1470@kindex --add-needed
1471@kindex --no-add-needed
1472@item --add-needed
1473@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1474These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1475their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1476options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1477and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1478
252b5132
RH
1479@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1480@item -assert @var{keyword}
1481This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1482
1483@kindex -Bdynamic
1484@kindex -dy
1485@kindex -call_shared
1486@item -Bdynamic
1487@itemx -dy
1488@itemx -call_shared
1489Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1490for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1491default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1492for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1493multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1494@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1495
a1ab1d2a
UD
1496@kindex -Bgroup
1497@item -Bgroup
1498Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1499section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1500object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1501@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1502only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1503
252b5132
RH
1504@kindex -Bstatic
1505@kindex -dn
1506@kindex -non_shared
1507@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1508@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1509@itemx -dn
1510@itemx -non_shared
1511@itemx -static
1512Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1513platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1514variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1515may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1516library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1517option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1518option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1519shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1520references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1521libraries.
252b5132
RH
1522
1523@kindex -Bsymbolic
1524@item -Bsymbolic
1525When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1526definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1527for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1528within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1529platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1530
40b36307
L
1531@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1532@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1533When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1534symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1535This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1536libraries.
40b36307 1537
55255dae
L
1538@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1539@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1540Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1541typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1542global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1543within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1544to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1545in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1546which support shared libraries.
1547
1548The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1549scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1550
40b36307
L
1551@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1552@item --dynamic-list-data
1553Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1554
1555@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1556@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1557Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1558is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1559
0b8a70d9
L
1560@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1561@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1562Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1563
252b5132
RH
1564@kindex --check-sections
1565@kindex --no-check-sections
1566@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1567@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1568Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1569been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1570perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1571suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1572allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1573restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1574Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1575force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1576option.
252b5132 1577
ddbb8a31
NC
1578@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1579@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1580@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1581@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1582This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1583by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1584command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1585output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1586input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1587specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1588follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1589behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1590
1591This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1592libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1593mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1594their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1595required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1596the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1597dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1598symbols.
1599
252b5132
RH
1600@cindex cross reference table
1601@kindex --cref
1602@item --cref
1603Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1604generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1605Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1606
1607The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1608easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1609sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1610symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1611definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1612where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1613symbol are listed.
252b5132 1614
5dba6f05
NA
1615@cindex ctf variables
1616@kindex --ctf-variables
1617@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1618@item --ctf-variables
1619@item --no-ctf-variables
1620The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1621types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1622table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1623conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1624usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1625@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1626The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1627
1628@cindex ctf type sharing
1629@kindex --ctf-share-types
1630@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1631Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1632
1633@table @samp
1634@item share-unconflicted
1635Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1636where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1637translation unit. This is the default.
1638
1639@item share-duplicated
1640Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1641dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1642dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1643always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1644larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1645large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1646consumer at runtime.
1647@end table
1648
4818e05f
AM
1649@cindex common allocation
1650@kindex --no-define-common
1651@item --no-define-common
1652This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1653The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1654@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1655
1656The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1657the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1658of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1659forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1660Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1661from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1662This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1663and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1664duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1665paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1666
7bdf4127
AB
1667@cindex group allocation in linker script
1668@cindex section groups
1669@cindex COMDAT
1670@kindex --force-group-allocation
1671@item --force-group-allocation
1672This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1673normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1674default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1675change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1676command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1677effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1678
252b5132 1679@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1680@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1681@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1682Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1683address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1684times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1685limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1686context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1687symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1688constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1689using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1690@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1691equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132
RH
1692
1693@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1694@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1695@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1696@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1697@itemx --no-demangle
1698These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1699and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1700present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1701underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1702mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1703different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1704to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1705demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1706is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1707
1708@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1709@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1710@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1711@item -I@var{file}
1712@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1713Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1714generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1715linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1716doing.
1717
9b8b325a
RF
1718@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1719@item --no-dynamic-linker
1720When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1721linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1722executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1723entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1724
a70f34c0
NC
1725@kindex --embedded-relocs
1726@item --embedded-relocs
1727This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1728that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1729is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1730targets.
1731
3f0a5f17
ME
1732@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1733@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1734Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1735in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1736
7ce691ae 1737@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1738@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1739@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1740@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1741Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1742with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1743
252b5132
RH
1744@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1745@item --force-exe-suffix
1746Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1747
1748If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1749@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1750the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1751option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1752Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1753it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1754
1755@kindex --gc-sections
1756@kindex --no-gc-sections
1757@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1758@item --gc-sections
1759@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1760Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1761targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1762performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1763@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1764collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1765implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1766
d5465ba2
AM
1767@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1768examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1769symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1770command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1771referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1772libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1773referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1774the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1775relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1776@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1777
ac69cbc6 1778This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1779@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1780specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1781@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1782command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1783
c17d87de
NC
1784@kindex --print-gc-sections
1785@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1786@cindex garbage collection
1787@item --print-gc-sections
1788@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1789List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1790printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1791collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1792default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1793be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1794line.
1795
22185505 1796@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1797@cindex garbage collection
1798@item --gc-keep-exported
1799When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1800collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1801default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1802executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1803collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1804Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1805it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1806ELF format targets.
1807
30824704
RM
1808@kindex --print-output-format
1809@cindex output format
1810@item --print-output-format
1811Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1812other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1813in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1814
3604cb1f
TG
1815@kindex --print-memory-usage
1816@cindex memory usage
1817@item --print-memory-usage
1818Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1819the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1820quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1821headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1822parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1823
1824@smallexample
1825Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1826 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1827 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1828@end smallexample
1829
252b5132
RH
1830@cindex help
1831@cindex usage
1832@kindex --help
1833@item --help
1834Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1835
ea20a7da
CC
1836@kindex --target-help
1837@item --target-help
a094d01f 1838Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1839
2509a395
SL
1840@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1841@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1842Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
72a3b182
NC
1843@option{-M} option, above. Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile}
1844causes the linker map to be written into a file inside the directory.
1845The name of the file is based upon the @var{output} filename with
1846@code{.map} appended.
252b5132
RH
1847
1848@cindex memory usage
1849@kindex --no-keep-memory
1850@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
1851@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1852symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 1853instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 1854necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
1855while linking a large executable.
1856
1857@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1858@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 1859@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 1860@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1861@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
1862Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1863is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1864The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
1865behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 1866libraries being linked in.
252b5132 1867
97a232d7
NC
1868The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
1869
aa713662
L
1870@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
1871@kindex -z muldefs
1872@item --allow-multiple-definition
1873@itemx -z muldefs
1874Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
1875report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
1876first definition will be used.
1877
b79e8c78 1878@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1879@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 1880@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1881@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 1882Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
1883This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
1884determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
1885shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
1886how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
1887
903249d7
NC
1888The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
1889referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
1890an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
1891a shared library.
1892
1893The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
1894libraries specified at link time are that:
1895
1896@itemize @bullet
1897@item
1898A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
1899that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
1900resolvable at load time.
1901@item
1902There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
1903symbols in shared libraries are normal.
1904
1905The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
1906select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
1907architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
1908appropriate memset function.
1909@end itemize
b79e8c78 1910
31941635
L
1911@kindex --no-undefined-version
1912@item --no-undefined-version
1913Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
1914it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
1915will be issued instead.
1916
3e3b46e5
PB
1917@kindex --default-symver
1918@item --default-symver
1919Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
1920exported symbols.
1921
1922@kindex --default-imported-symver
1923@item --default-imported-symver
1924Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
1925imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 1926
252b5132
RH
1927@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
1928@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 1929Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
1930files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
1931been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 1932This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
1933errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
1934have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
1935inappropriate.
1936
fe7929ce
AM
1937@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
1938@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
1939Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
1940library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
1941
252b5132
RH
1942@kindex --no-whole-archive
1943@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 1944Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
1945archive files.
1946
1947@cindex output file after errors
1948@kindex --noinhibit-exec
1949@item --noinhibit-exec
1950Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
1951Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
1952errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
1953when it issues any error whatsoever.
1954
0a9c1c8e
CD
1955@kindex -nostdlib
1956@item -nostdlib
1957Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
1958command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
1959(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
1960
252b5132 1961@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
1962@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
1963@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
1964@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
1965file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 1966@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
1967object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
1968object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
1969should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
1970usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
1971name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
1972list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
1973command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
1974this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
1975@end ifclear
1976
76359541
TP
1977@kindex --out-implib
1978@item --out-implib @var{file}
1979Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
1980the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
1981library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
1982may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
1983behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
1984step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
1985the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
1986
36af4a4e
JJ
1987@kindex -pie
1988@kindex --pic-executable
1989@item -pie
1990@itemx --pic-executable
1991@cindex position independent executables
1992Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
1993ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
1994libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 1995address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
1996normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
1997defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
1998
252b5132
RH
1999@kindex -qmagic
2000@item -qmagic
2001This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2002
2003@kindex -Qy
2004@item -Qy
2005This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2006
2007@kindex --relax
2008@cindex synthesizing linker
2009@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2010@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2011@item --relax
28d5f677 2012@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2013An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2014@ifset GENERIC
2015This option is only supported on a few targets.
2016@end ifset
2017@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2018@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2019@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2020@ifset XTENSA
2021@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2022@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2023@ifset M68HC11
2024@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2025@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2026@ifset NIOSII
2027@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2028@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2029@ifset POWERPC
2030@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2031@end ifset
252b5132 2032
ccd9fae5 2033On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2034global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2035addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2036synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2037instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2038
2039On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2040debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2041@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2042This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2043family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2044@end ifset
2045
ccd9fae5
NC
2046On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2047@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2048
ccd9fae5
NC
2049On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2050and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2051
252b5132
RH
2052@cindex retaining specified symbols
2053@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2054@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2055@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2056@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2057Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2058discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2059symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2060@ifset GENERIC
2061(such as VxWorks)
2062@end ifset
2063where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2064run-time memory.
2065
2066@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2067or symbols needed for relocations.
2068
2069You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2070line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2071
2072@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2073@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2074@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2075@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2076Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2077linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2078arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2079them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2080
2081The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2082are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2083description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2084in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2085have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2086
2087If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2088contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2089is defined.
252b5132 2090
ff5dcc92 2091The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2092SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2093@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2094runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2095options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2096gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2097file systems.
252b5132 2098
ff5dcc92 2099For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2100followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2101the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2102@end ifset
2103
2104@ifset GENERIC
2105@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2106@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2107@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2108When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2109happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2110of the input files.
2111
2112When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2113non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2114shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2115explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2116specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2117@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2118either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2119appearing multiple times.
2120
e680a6b6
NC
2121The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2122directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2123containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2124and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
212564-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2126
2127The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2128@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2129supported.
2130
28c309a2
NC
2131This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2132that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2133is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2134runtime linker would do.
2135
252b5132 2136The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2137libraries:
d8e4137b 2138
252b5132
RH
2139@enumerate
2140@item
ff5dcc92 2141Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2142@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2143Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2144between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2145specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2146used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2147at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2148by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2149the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2150@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2151On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2152@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2153environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2154@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2155On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2156directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2157@item
a1b8d843 2158For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2159variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2160@item
ec4eb78a
L
2161For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2162@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2163libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2164@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2165@item
252b5132
RH
2166The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2167@item
d8e4137b
NC
2168For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2169exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2170to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2171defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2172configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2173@item
2174For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2175the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2176header file.
2177@item
2178Any directories specifed by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in the
2179linker script being used.
252b5132
RH
2180@end enumerate
2181
2182If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2183warning and continue with the link.
2184@end ifset
2185
2186@kindex -shared
2187@kindex -Bshareable
2188@item -shared
2189@itemx -Bshareable
2190@cindex shared libraries
2191Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2192and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2193shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2194undefined symbols in the link.
2195
252b5132 2196@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2197@item --sort-common
2198@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2199@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2200This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2201ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2202sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2203eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2204between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2205specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2206
2509a395
SL
2207@kindex --sort-section=name
2208@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2209This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2210patterns in the linker script.
2211
2509a395
SL
2212@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2213@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2214This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2215patterns in the linker script.
2216
a70f34c0
NC
2217@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2218@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2219This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2220.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2221post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2222
252b5132 2223@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2224@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2225Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2226each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2227size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2228
2229@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2230@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2231Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2232output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2233This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2234certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2235cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2236that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2237support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2238input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2239more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2240many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2241
2242@kindex --stats
2243@item --stats
2244Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2245as execution time and memory usage.
2246
2509a395 2247@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2248@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2249Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2250configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2251that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2252
a70f34c0
NC
2253@kindex --task-link
2254@item --task-link
2255This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2256file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2257
252b5132
RH
2258@kindex --traditional-format
2259@cindex traditional format
2260@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2261For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2262the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2263use the traditional format instead.
2264
2265@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2266For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2267symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2268full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2269@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2270trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2271combine duplicate entries.
2272
2509a395
SL
2273@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2274@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2275Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2276address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2277times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2278line.
2279@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2280for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2281@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2282should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2283sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2284
2509a395
SL
2285@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2286@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2287@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2288@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2289@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2290@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2291@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2292Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2293@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2294
2509a395
SL
2295@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2296@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2297@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2298When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2299byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2300
9d5777a3
RM
2301@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2302@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2303@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2304When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2305the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2306text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2307
0d705e9f
AM
2308@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2309@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2310@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2311When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2312model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2313
560e09e9
NC
2314@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2315@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2316Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2317values for @samp{method}:
2318
2319@table @samp
2320@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2321Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2322
2323@item report-all
da8bce14 2324Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2325
2326@item ignore-in-object-files
2327Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2328ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2329
2330@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2331Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2332ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2333when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2334libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2335command line.
2336@end table
2337
2338The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2339by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2340
2341Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2342unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2343can change this to a warning.
2344
1715a13c
L
2345@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2346@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2347@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2348@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2349Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2350supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2351the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2352argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2353
2354@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2355@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2356@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2357Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2358used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2359about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2360is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2361see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2362use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2363symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2364@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2365
7ce691ae 2366@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2367@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2368@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2369@item --warn-common
2370Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2371a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2372but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2373you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2374Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2375warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2376
2377There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2378
2379@table @samp
2380@item int i = 1;
2381A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2382file.
2383
2384@item extern int i;
2385An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2386There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2387variable somewhere.
2388
2389@item int i;
2390A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2391variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2392The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2393single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2394size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2395a definition of the same variable.
2396@end table
2397
2398The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2399Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2400just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2401encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2402a common symbol.
2403
2404@enumerate
2405@item
2406Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2407definition for the symbol.
2408@smallexample
2409@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2410 overridden by definition
2411@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2412@end smallexample
2413
2414@item
2415Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2416the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2417except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2418@smallexample
2419@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2420 overriding common
2421@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2422@end smallexample
2423
2424@item
2425Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2426@smallexample
2427@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2428 of `@var{symbol}'
2429@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2430@end smallexample
2431
2432@item
2433Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2434@smallexample
2435@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2436 overridden by larger common
2437@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2438@end smallexample
2439
2440@item
2441Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2442the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2443encountered in a different order.
2444@smallexample
2445@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2446 overriding smaller common
2447@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2448@end smallexample
2449@end enumerate
2450
2451@kindex --warn-constructors
2452@item --warn-constructors
2453Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2454object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2455detect the use of global constructors.
2456
2457@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2458@item --warn-multiple-gp
2459Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2460This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2461Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2462section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2463of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2464base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2465base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2466bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2467large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2468values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2469option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2470
2471@kindex --warn-once
2472@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2473@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2474@item --warn-once
2475Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2476which refers to it.
2477
2478@kindex --warn-section-align
2479@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2480@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2481@item --warn-section-align
2482Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2483alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2484The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2485is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2486the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2487
a6dbf402
L
2488@kindex --warn-textrel
2489@item --warn-textrel
2490Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2491or shared object.
8fdd7217 2492
a0c402a5
L
2493@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2494@item --warn-alternate-em
2495Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2496
560e09e9
NC
2497@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2498@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2499If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2500@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2501This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2502
2503@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2504@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2505This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2506it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2507
252b5132
RH
2508@kindex --whole-archive
2509@cindex including an entire archive
2510@item --whole-archive
2511For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2512@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2513in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2514files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2515library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2516library. This option may be used more than once.
2517
7ec229ce 2518Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2519about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2520Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2521list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2522your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2523
2509a395
SL
2524@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2525@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2526Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2527@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2528undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2529@var{symbol}.
2530
2531This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2532wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2533wishes to call the system function, it should call
2534@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2535
2536Here is a trivial example:
2537
2538@smallexample
2539void *
cc2f008e 2540__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2541@{
cc2f008e 2542 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2543 return __real_malloc (c);
2544@}
2545@end smallexample
2546
ff5dcc92 2547If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2548all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2549instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2550call the real @code{malloc} function.
2551
2552You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2553links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2554you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2555file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2556call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2557
4ea904ed
SH
2558Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2559internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2560@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2561@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2562
2563@smallexample
2564int
2565f (void)
2566@{
2567 return 123;
2568@}
2569
2570int
2571g (void)
2572@{
2573 return f();
2574@}
2575@end smallexample
2576
6aa29e7b 2577@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2578@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2579@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2580@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2581Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2582(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2583section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2584
e41b3a13
JJ
2585@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2586@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2587Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2588generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2589if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2590
6c1439be
L
2591@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2592@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2593@item --enable-new-dtags
2594@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2595This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2596systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2597@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2598and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2599If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2600created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2601those options are only available for ELF systems.
2602
2d643429 2603@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2604@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2605Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2606close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2607time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2608increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2609value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2610
fdc90cb4
JJ
2611@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2612@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2613Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2614@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2615new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2616the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2617hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2618but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2619
0ce398f1
L
2620@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2621@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2622@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2623@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2624@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2625@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2626@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2627@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
9af89fba
NC
2628On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2629compressed using zlib.
2630
2631@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2632sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2633DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2634instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2635also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2636sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2637
2638The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2639@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2640
2641Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2642sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2643for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2644uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2645
2646The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2647involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2648default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2649@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2650
35835446
JR
2651@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2652@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2653This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2654linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2655for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2656about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2657
4f9c04f7 2658Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 26591021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2660run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2661has been used.
2662
2663The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2664enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2665
c0065db7
RM
2666@kindex --build-id
2667@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2668@item --build-id
2669@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2670Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2671or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2672unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2673@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2674@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2675@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2676the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2677string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2678@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2679is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2680
2681The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2682that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2683unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2684to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2685file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2686string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2687
2688Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2689@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
252b5132
RH
2690@end table
2691
0285c67d
NC
2692@c man end
2693
36f63dca 2694@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2695
0285c67d
NC
2696@c man begin OPTIONS
2697
ff5dcc92 2698The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2699the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2700normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2701use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2702@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2703like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2704symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2705object file).
2706
2707In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2708support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2709PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2710values by either a space or an equals sign.
2711
ff5dcc92 2712@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2713
2714@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2715@item --add-stdcall-alias
2716If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2717as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2718[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2719
2720@kindex --base-file
2721@item --base-file @var{file}
2722Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2723addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2724@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2725[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2726
2727@kindex --dll
2728@item --dll
2729Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 2730@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 2731file.
bb10df36 2732[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2733
88183869
DK
2734@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2735@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2736@item --enable-long-section-names
2737@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 2738The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 2739the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
2740for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2741fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
2742to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2743allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2744disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2745generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2746as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
2747with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2748GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
2749information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2750option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2751section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2752when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2753image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
2754[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2755
252b5132
RH
2756@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2757@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2758@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2759@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2760If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 2761do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
2762only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2763resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2764undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2765@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2766to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2767warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2768import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 2769to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 2770feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 2771@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 2772mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 2773[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2774
522f09cd
KT
2775@kindex --leading-underscore
2776@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2777@item --leading-underscore
2778@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2779For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2780in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2781disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2782
252b5132
RH
2783@cindex DLLs, creating
2784@kindex --export-all-symbols
2785@item --export-all-symbols
2786If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2787be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2788otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2789explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2790attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2791option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 2792@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 2793@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
2794exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2795re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2796such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2797@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
2798@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2799Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2800not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 2801extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 2802(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 2803These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 2804@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 2805@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 2806@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 2807@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 2808[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2809
2810@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 2811@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
2812Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2813exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 2814[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2815
2927aaca
NC
2816@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2817@item --exclude-all-symbols
2818Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2819[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2820
252b5132
RH
2821@kindex --file-alignment
2822@item --file-alignment
2823Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2824file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2825512.
bb10df36 2826[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2827
2828@cindex heap size
2829@kindex --heap
2830@item --heap @var{reserve}
2831@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 2832Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 2833to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 2834committed.
bb10df36 2835[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2836
2837@cindex image base
2838@kindex --image-base
2839@item --image-base @var{value}
2840Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
2841the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
2842is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
2843your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
2844other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
2845for dlls.
bb10df36 2846[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2847
2848@kindex --kill-at
2849@item --kill-at
2850If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
2851symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 2852[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2853
26d2d8a2
BF
2854@kindex --large-address-aware
2855@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 2856If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 2857header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 2858greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
2859or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
2860section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
2861[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2862
f69a2f97
NC
2863@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
2864@item --disable-large-address-aware
2865Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
2866This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
2867driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
2868addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
2869[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2870
252b5132
RH
2871@kindex --major-image-version
2872@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2873Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 2874[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2875
2876@kindex --major-os-version
2877@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2878Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 2879[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2880
2881@kindex --major-subsystem-version
2882@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2883Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 2884[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2885
2886@kindex --minor-image-version
2887@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2888Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2889[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2890
2891@kindex --minor-os-version
2892@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2893Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2894[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2895
2896@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
2897@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2898Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2899[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2900
2901@cindex DEF files, creating
2902@cindex DLLs, creating
2903@kindex --output-def
2904@item --output-def @var{file}
2905The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
2906file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
2907(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
2908library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
2909automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 2910[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2911
b044cda1 2912@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
2913@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
2914@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
2915@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
2916Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
2917@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
2918By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
2919for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
2920execution are avoided.
bb10df36 2921[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2922
2923@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
2924@item --disable-auto-image-base
2925Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
2926user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
2927default.
bb10df36 2928[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2929
2930@cindex DLLs, linking to
2931@kindex --dll-search-prefix
2932@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 2933When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 2934search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 2935@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
2936between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
2937uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 2938@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 2939[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2940
2941@kindex --enable-auto-import
2942@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 2943Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
2944DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
2945mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
2946[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2947
2948The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
2949feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
2950
2951Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
2952of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
2953PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 2954
e2a83dd0
NC
2955Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
2956data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
2957placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
2958around a problem with consts that is described here:
2959http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
2960
4d8907ac
DS
2961Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
2962see this message:
0d888aac 2963
ece2d90e 2964"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
2965documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
2966
ece2d90e
NC
2967This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
2968ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
2969allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
2970fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
2971constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
2972multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
2973this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
2974of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
2975the warning, and exit.
2976
2977There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
2978data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 2979
2fa9fc65
NC
2980One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
2981of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 2982this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 2983
c0065db7
RM
2984A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
2985that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
2986there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
2987a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
2988
2989@example
2990extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 2991extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
2992 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
2993@end example
2994
2995or
2996
2997@example
2998extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 2999extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3000 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3001@end example
3002
c0065db7 3003For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3004is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3005
3006@example
3007extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3008extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3009 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3010@end example
3011
c406afaf
NC
3012or
3013
3014@example
3015extern long long extern_ll;
3016extern_ll -->
3017 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3018@end example
3019
2fa9fc65 3020A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3021'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3022@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3023requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3024building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3025merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3026between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3027constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3028
3029Original:
3030@example
3031--foo.h
3032extern int arr[];
3033--foo.c
3034#include "foo.h"
3035void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3036 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3037@}
3038@end example
3039
3040Solution 1:
3041@example
3042--foo.h
3043extern int arr[];
3044--foo.c
3045#include "foo.h"
3046void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3047 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3048 volatile int *parr = arr;
3049 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3050@}
3051@end example
3052
3053Solution 2:
3054@example
3055--foo.h
3056/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3057#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3058 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3059#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3060#else
3061#define FOO_IMPORT
3062#endif
3063extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3064--foo.c
3065#include "foo.h"
3066void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3067 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3068@}
3069@end example
3070
c0065db7 3071A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3072library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3073for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3074functions).
b044cda1
CW
3075
3076@kindex --disable-auto-import
3077@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3078Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3079@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3080[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3081
2fa9fc65
NC
3082@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3083@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3084If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3085that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3086a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3087environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3088[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3089
3090@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3091@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3092Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3093[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3094
b044cda1
CW
3095@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3096@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3097Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3098[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3099
252b5132
RH
3100@kindex --section-alignment
3101@item --section-alignment
3102Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3103addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3104[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3105
3106@cindex stack size
3107@kindex --stack
3108@item --stack @var{reserve}
3109@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3110Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3111to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3112committed.
bb10df36 3113[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3114
3115@kindex --subsystem
3116@item --subsystem @var{which}
3117@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3118@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3119Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3120legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3121@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3122the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3123@var{which}.
bb10df36 3124[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3125
2f563b51
DK
3126The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3127of the PE file header:
3128[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3129
2d5c3743
NC
3130@kindex --high-entropy-va
3131@item --high-entropy-va
3132Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
3133(ASLR).
dc9bd8c9
HD
3134This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3135@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3136
2f563b51
DK
3137@kindex --dynamicbase
3138@item --dynamicbase
3139The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3140randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
3141Vista for i386 PE targets.
dc9bd8c9 3142This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3143
3144@kindex --forceinteg
3145@item --forceinteg
3146Code integrity checks are enforced.
3147
3148@kindex --nxcompat
3149@item --nxcompat
3150The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
3151This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE targets.
3152
3153@kindex --no-isolation
3154@item --no-isolation
3155Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
3156
3157@kindex --no-seh
3158@item --no-seh
3159The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
3160this image.
3161
3162@kindex --no-bind
3163@item --no-bind
3164Do not bind this image.
3165
3166@kindex --wdmdriver
3167@item --wdmdriver
3168The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model.
9d5777a3 3169
2f563b51
DK
3170@kindex --tsaware
3171@item --tsaware
3172The image is Terminal Server aware.
3173
0cb112f7
CF
3174@kindex --insert-timestamp
3175@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3176@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3177Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3178as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3179other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3180will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3181same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3182can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3183that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3184identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3185
3186@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3187@item --enable-reloc-section
3188Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3189is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
252b5132
RH
3190@end table
3191
0285c67d
NC
3192@c man end
3193
ac145307
BS
3194@ifset C6X
3195@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3196
3197@c man begin OPTIONS
3198
3199The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3200libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3201all executables use an index of 0.
3202
3203@table @gcctabopt
3204
3205@kindex --dsbt-size
3206@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3207This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3208or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3209entries.
3210
3211@kindex --dsbt-index
3212@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3213This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3214to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3215executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3216@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3217
fbd9ad90
PB
3218@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3219The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3220exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3221
ac145307
BS
3222@end table
3223
3224@c man end
3225@end ifset
3226
b8891f8d
AJ
3227@ifset CSKY
3228@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3229
3230@c man begin OPTIONS
3231
3232@table @gcctabopt
3233
3234@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3235@item --branch-stub
3236This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3237sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3238usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3239can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3240the compiler or assembler.
3241
3242@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3243@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3244This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3245It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3246be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3247stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3248sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3249@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3250linker should choose suitable defaults.
3251
3252@end table
3253
3254@c man end
3255@end ifset
3256
93fd0973
SC
3257@ifset M68HC11
3258@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3259
3260@c man begin OPTIONS
3261
3262The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3263memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3264
3265@table @gcctabopt
3266
3267@kindex --no-trampoline
3268@item --no-trampoline
3269This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3270is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3271instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3272
3273@kindex --bank-window
3274@item --bank-window @var{name}
3275This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3276the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3277The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3278paging and addresses within the memory window.
3279
3280@end table
3281
3282@c man end
3283@end ifset
3284
7fb9f789
NC
3285@ifset M68K
3286@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3287
3288@c man begin OPTIONS
3289
3290The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3291when linking for 68K targets.
3292
3293@table @gcctabopt
3294
3295@kindex --got
3296@item --got=@var{type}
3297This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3298@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3299@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3300Info entry for @file{ld}.
3301
3302@end table
3303
3304@c man end
3305@end ifset
3306
833794fc
MR
3307@ifset MIPS
3308@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3309
3310@c man begin OPTIONS
3311
3312The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3313generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3314linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3315
3316@table @gcctabopt
3317
3318@kindex --insn32
3319@item --insn32
3320@kindex --no-insn32
3321@itemx --no-insn32
3322These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3323generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3324or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
332532-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3326used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3327possible.
3328
8b10b0b3
MR
3329@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3330@item --ignore-branch-isa
3331@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3332@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3333These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3334transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3335accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3336is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3337instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3338equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3339calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3340a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3341an error.
3342
3734320d
MF
3343@kindex --compact-branches
3344@item --compact-branches
3345@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3346@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3347These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3348in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3349
833794fc
MR
3350@end table
3351
3352@c man end
3353@end ifset
3354
fa1477dc
SC
3355
3356@ifset PDP11
3357@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3358
3359@c man begin OPTIONS
3360
3361For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3362produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3363for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3364targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3365defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3366here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3367
3368@table @gcctabopt
3369
3370@kindex -N
3371@item -N
3372@kindex --omagic
3373@itemx --omagic
3374
3375Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3376indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3377shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3378writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3379the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3380programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3381from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3382
3383@kindex -n
3384@item -n
3385@kindex --nmagic
3386@itemx --nmagic
3387
3388Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3389indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3390be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3391file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3392byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3393a @emph{pure executable} format.
3394
3395@kindex -z
3396@item -z
3397@kindex --imagic
3398@itemx --imagic
3399
3400Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3401indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3402data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3403instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3404larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3405to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3406shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3407option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3408and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3409this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3410executable} format.
3411
3412@kindex --no-omagic
3413@item --no-omagic
3414
3415Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3416
3417@end table
3418
3419@c man end
3420@end ifset
3421
252b5132
RH
3422@ifset UsesEnvVars
3423@node Environment
3424@section Environment Variables
3425
0285c67d
NC
3426@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3427
560e09e9 3428You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3429@ifclear SingleFormat
3430@code{GNUTARGET},
3431@end ifclear
3432@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3433
36f63dca 3434@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3435@kindex GNUTARGET
3436@cindex default input format
3437@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3438use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3439of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3440@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3441of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3442attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3443this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3444there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3445object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3446BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3447in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3448@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3449
3450@kindex LDEMULATION
3451@cindex default emulation
3452@cindex emulation, default
3453@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3454@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3455behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3456available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3457the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3458variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3459linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3460
3461@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3462@cindex demangling, default
3463Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3464@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3465default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3466a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3467may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3468options.
3469
0285c67d
NC
3470@c man end
3471@end ifset
3472
252b5132
RH
3473@node Scripts
3474@chapter Linker Scripts
3475
3476@cindex scripts
3477@cindex linker scripts
3478@cindex command files
3479Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3480written in the linker command language.
3481
3482The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3483the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3484the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3485more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3486direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3487described below.
3488
3489The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3490yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3491linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3492to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3493such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3494
3495You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3496line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3497default linker script.
3498
3499You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3500to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3501Linker Scripts}.
3502
3503@menu
3504* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3505* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3506* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3507* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3508* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3509* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3510* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3511* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3512* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3513* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3514* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3515@end menu
3516
3517@node Basic Script Concepts
3518@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3519@cindex linker script concepts
3520We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3521describe the linker script language.
3522
3523The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3524file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3525@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3526The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3527purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3528among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3529section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3530in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3531
3532Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3533also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3534contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3535the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3536A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3537area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3538loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3539which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3540of debugging information.
3541
3542Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3543first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3544the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3545@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3546section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3547same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3548is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3549(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3550based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3551RAM address would be the VMA.
3552
3553You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3554program with the @samp{-h} option.
3555
3556Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3557@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3558has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3559information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3560will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3561static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3562referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3563
3564You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3565program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3566option.
3567
3568@node Script Format
3569@section Linker Script Format
3570@cindex linker script format
3571Linker scripts are text files.
3572
3573You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3574either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3575symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3576generally ignored.
3577
3578Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3579If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3580otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3581double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3582file name.
3583
3584You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3585@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3586to whitespace.
3587
3588@node Simple Example
3589@section Simple Linker Script Example
3590@cindex linker script example
3591@cindex example of linker script
3592Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3593
3594The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3595@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3596memory layout of the output file.
3597
3598The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3599describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3600code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3601@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3602Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3603your input files.
3604
3605For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
36060x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3607linker script which will do that:
3608@smallexample
3609SECTIONS
3610@{
3611 . = 0x10000;
3612 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3613 . = 0x8000000;
3614 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3615 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3616@}
3617@end smallexample
3618
3619You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3620followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3621descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3622
252b5132
RH
3623The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3624sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3625counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3626other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3627current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3628incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3629@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3630
3631The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3632required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3633after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3634which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3635wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3636means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3637
3638Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3639@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3640@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3641
3642The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3643the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3644at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3645output section, the value of the location counter will be
3646@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3647effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3648immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3649
3650The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3651alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3652example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3653sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3654may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3655sections.
3656
3657That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3658
3659@node Simple Commands
3660@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3661@cindex linker script simple commands
3662In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3663
3664@menu
3665* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3666* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3667@ifclear SingleFormat
3668* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3669@end ifclear
3670
4a93e180 3671* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3672* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3673@end menu
3674
3675@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3676@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3677@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3678@cindex start of execution
3679@cindex first instruction
3680@cindex entry point
3681The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3682point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3683entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3684@smallexample
3685ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3686@end smallexample
3687
3688There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3689entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3690stopping when one of them succeeds:
3691@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3692@item
252b5132 3693the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3694@item
252b5132 3695the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3696@item
a094d01f 3697the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3698targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3699check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3700@item
252b5132 3701the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
a1ab1d2a 3702@item
252b5132
RH
3703The address @code{0}.
3704@end itemize
3705
3706@node File Commands
36f63dca 3707@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
3708@cindex linker script file commands
3709Several linker script commands deal with files.
3710
3711@table @code
3712@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3713@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3714@cindex including a linker script
3715Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3716be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 3717with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
371810 levels deep.
3719
4006703d
NS
3720You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3721@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3722
252b5132
RH
3723@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3724@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3725@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3726@cindex input files in linker scripts
3727@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3728@cindex linker script input object files
3729The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3730in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3731
3732For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3733a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3734then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3735
3736In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3737script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3738
e3f2db7f
AO
3739In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3740with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3741located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
3742for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3743@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3744filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3745@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3746
3747If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3748the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3749found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3750not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3751path.
252b5132 3752
ff5dcc92 3753If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 3754name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
3755@samp{-l}.
3756
3757When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3758files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3759script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3760
3761@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3762@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3763@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3764@cindex grouping input files
3765The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3766files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3767new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 3768in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 3769
b717d30e
JJ
3770@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3771@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3772@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3773This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3774commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3775as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3776with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3777when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3778@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3779and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3780setting afterwards.
3781
252b5132
RH
3782@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3783@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 3784@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
3785The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3786@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3787@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 3788Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
3789precedence.
3790
3791You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3792output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3793
3794@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3795@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3796@cindex library search path in linker script
3797@cindex archive search path in linker script
3798@cindex search path in linker script
3799The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 3800@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 3801@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 3802on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 3803are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 3804the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
3805
3806@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3807@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3808@cindex first input file
3809The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3810that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
3811though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
3812when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
3813first file.
3814@end table
3815
3816@ifclear SingleFormat
3817@node Format Commands
36f63dca 3818@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
3819A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
3820
3821@table @code
3822@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3823@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
3824@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3825@cindex output file format in linker script
3826The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
3827output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 3828exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3829(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
3830line option takes precedence.
3831
3832You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 3833formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
3834This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
3835desired endianness.
3836
3837If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
3838will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
3839output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
3840used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
3841
3842For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
3843command:
3844@smallexample
3845OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
3846@end smallexample
3847This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 3848@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
3849option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
3850format.
3851
3852@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3853@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3854@cindex input file format in linker script
3855The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
3856files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
3857This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3858(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
3859is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
3860command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
3861@end table
3862@end ifclear
3863
4a93e180
NC
3864@node REGION_ALIAS
3865@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
3866@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3867@cindex region alias
3868@cindex region names
3869
3870Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
3871@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
3872
3873@smallexample
3874REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3875@end smallexample
3876
3877The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
3878memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
3879to memory regions. An example follows.
3880
3881Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
3882memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
3883that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
3884non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
3885access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
3886read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
3887sections:
3888
3889@itemize @bullet
3890@item
3891@code{.text} program code;
3892@item
3893@code{.rodata} read-only data;
3894@item
3895@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
3896@item
3897@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
3898@end itemize
3899
3900The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
3901part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
3902output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
3903systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
3904@code{C}:
3905@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
3906@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 3907@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
3908@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
3909@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
3910@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
3911@end multitable
3912The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
3913loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
3914the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
3915the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
3916
3917The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
3918includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
3919memory layout:
3920@smallexample
3921INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
3922
3923SECTIONS
3924 @{
3925 .text :
3926 @{
3927 *(.text)
3928 @} > REGION_TEXT
3929 .rodata :
3930 @{
3931 *(.rodata)
3932 rodata_end = .;
3933 @} > REGION_RODATA
3934 .data : AT (rodata_end)
3935 @{
3936 data_start = .;
3937 *(.data)
3938 @} > REGION_DATA
3939 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
3940 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
3941 .bss :
3942 @{
3943 *(.bss)
3944 @} > REGION_BSS
3945 @}
3946@end smallexample
3947
3948Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
3949regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
3950variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
3951@table @code
3952@item A
3953Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
3954@smallexample
3955MEMORY
3956 @{
3957 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
3958 @}
3959
3960REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
3961REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
3962REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
3963REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
3964@end smallexample
3965@item B
3966Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
3967into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
3968@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
3969@smallexample
3970MEMORY
3971 @{
3972 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
3973 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
3974 @}
3975
3976REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
3977REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
3978REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
3979REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
3980@end smallexample
3981@item C
3982Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
3983@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
3984initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
3985system start into the @code{RAM}.
3986@smallexample
3987MEMORY
3988 @{
3989 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
3990 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
3991 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
3992 @}
3993
3994REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
3995REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
3996REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
3997REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
3998@end smallexample
3999@end table
4000
4001It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4002@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4003necessary:
4004@smallexample
4005#include <string.h>
4006
4007extern char data_start [];
4008extern char data_size [];
4009extern char data_load_start [];
4010
4011void copy_data(void)
4012@{
4013 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4014 @{
4015 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4016 @}
4017@}
4018@end smallexample
4019
252b5132 4020@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4021@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4022There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4023
4024@table @code
4025@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4026@kindex ASSERT
4027@cindex assertion in linker script
4028Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4029with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4030
fd1c4238
NC
4031Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4032take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4033inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4034for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4035symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4036
4037@smallexample
4038 .stack :
4039 @{
4040 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4041 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4042 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4043 @}
4044@end smallexample
4045
4046will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4047PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4048can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4049
4050@smallexample
4051 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4052 .stack :
4053 @{
4054 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4055 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4056 @}
4057@end smallexample
4058
4059will work.
4060
252b5132
RH
4061@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4062@kindex EXTERN
4063@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4064Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4065symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4066modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4067each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4068command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4069
4070@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4071@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4072@cindex common allocation in linker script
4073This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4074to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4075output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4076
4818e05f
AM
4077@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4078@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4079@cindex common allocation in linker script
4080This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4081command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4082to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4083
7bdf4127
AB
4084@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4085@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4086@cindex group allocation in linker script
4087@cindex section groups
4088@cindex COMDAT
4089This command has the same effect as the
4090@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4091@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4092and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4093specified (@samp{-r}).
4094
53d25da6
AM
4095@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4096@kindex INSERT
4097@cindex insert user script into default script
4098This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4099augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4100inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4101@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4102default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4103sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4104linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4105insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4106linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4107default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4108of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4109to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4110is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4111
4112@smallexample
4113SECTIONS
4114@{
4115 OVERLAY :
4116 @{
4117 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4118 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4119 @}
4120@}
4121INSERT AFTER .text;
4122@end smallexample
4123
252b5132
RH
4124@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4125@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4126@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4127This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4128references among certain output sections.
4129
4130In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4131using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4132will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4133errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4134a function defined in the other section.
4135
4136The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4137@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4138an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4139@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4140names.
4141
cdf96953
MF
4142@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4143@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4144@cindex cross references
4145This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4146references to one section from a list of other sections.
4147
4148The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4149output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4150a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4151there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4152must never call back.
4153
4154The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4155The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4156If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4157the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4158status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4159names, not input section names.
4160
252b5132
RH
4161@ifclear SingleFormat
4162@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4163@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4164@cindex machine architecture
4165@cindex architecture
4166Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4167of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4168architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4169the @samp{-f} option.
4170@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4171
4172@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4173@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4174This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4175@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4176in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4177@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4178@end table
4179
4180@node Assignments
4181@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4182@cindex assignment in scripts
4183@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4184@cindex variables, defining
4185You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4186the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4187
4188@menu
4189* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4190* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4191* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4192* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4193* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4194@end menu
4195
4196@node Simple Assignments
4197@subsection Simple Assignments
4198
4199You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4200
4201@table @code
4202@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4203@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4204@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4205@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4206@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4207@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4208@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4209@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4210@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4211@end table
4212
4213The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4214@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4215defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4216
4217The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4218may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4219
4220The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4221
4222Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4223
4224You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4225statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4226section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4227
4228The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4229expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4230
4231Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4232assignments may be used:
4233
4234@smallexample
4235floating_point = 0;
4236SECTIONS
4237@{
4238 .text :
4239 @{
4240 *(.text)
4241 _etext = .;
4242 @}
156e34dd 4243 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4244 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4245@}
4246@end smallexample
4247@noindent
4248In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4249zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4250the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4251defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4252upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4253
eb8476a6
MR
4254@node HIDDEN
4255@subsection HIDDEN
4256@cindex HIDDEN
4257For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4258exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4259
4260Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4261@code{HIDDEN}:
4262
4263@smallexample
4264HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4265SECTIONS
4266@{
4267 .text :
4268 @{
4269 *(.text)
4270 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4271 @}
4272 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4273 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4274@}
4275@end smallexample
4276@noindent
4277In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4278
252b5132
RH
4279@node PROVIDE
4280@subsection PROVIDE
4281@cindex PROVIDE
4282In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4283only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4284the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4285@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4286@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4287@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4288@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4289@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4290
4291Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4292@smallexample
4293SECTIONS
4294@{
4295 .text :
4296 @{
4297 *(.text)
4298 _etext = .;
4299 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4300 @}
4301@}
4302@end smallexample
4303
4304In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4305underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition error. If, on
4306the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4307underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4308If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4309linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4310
b0daac83
NC
4311Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4312defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4313that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4314when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4315@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4316
7af8e998
L
4317@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4318@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4319@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4320Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4321hidden and won't be exported.
4322
73ae6183
NC
4323@node Source Code Reference
4324@subsection Source Code Reference
4325
4326Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4327intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4328a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4329symbol that does not have a value.
4330
4331Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4332transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4333stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4334prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4335mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4336of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4337variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4338linker script variable might be referred to as:
4339
4340@smallexample
4341 extern int foo;
4342@end smallexample
4343
4344But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4345
4346@smallexample
4347 _foo = 1000;
4348@end smallexample
4349
4350In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4351transformation has taken place.
4352
4353When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4354things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4355in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4356second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4357table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4358contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4359value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4360
4361@smallexample
4362 int foo = 1000;
4363@end smallexample
4364
10bf6894 4365creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4366holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4367number 1000 is initially stored.
4368
4369When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4370first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4371memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4372So:
4373
4374@smallexample
4375 foo = 1;
4376@end smallexample
4377
4378looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4379associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4380address. Whereas:
4381
4382@smallexample
4383 int * a = & foo;
4384@end smallexample
4385
10bf6894 4386looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4387and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4388the variable @samp{a}.
4389
4390Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4391the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4392an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4393
4394@smallexample
4395 foo = 1000;
4396@end smallexample
4397
4398creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4399the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4400address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4401linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4402access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4403
4404Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4405you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4406use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4407section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4408linker script contains these declarations:
4409
4410@smallexample
4411@group
4412 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4413 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4414 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4415@end group
4416@end smallexample
4417
4418Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4419
4420@smallexample
4421@group
4422 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4423
73ae6183
NC
4424 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4425@end group
4426@end smallexample
4427
4428Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4429Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4430arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4431
4432@smallexample
4433@group
4434 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4435
4436 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4437@end group
4438@end smallexample
4439
4440Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4441operators.
73ae6183 4442
252b5132 4443@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4444@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4445@kindex SECTIONS
4446The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4447into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4448
4449The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4450@smallexample
4451SECTIONS
4452@{
4453 @var{sections-command}
4454 @var{sections-command}
4455 @dots{}
4456@}
4457@end smallexample
4458
4459Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4460
4461@itemize @bullet
4462@item
4463an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4464@item
4465a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4466@item
4467an output section description
4468@item
4469an overlay description
4470@end itemize
4471
4472The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4473@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4474those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4475understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4476the layout of the output file.
4477
4478Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4479below.
4480
4481If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4482linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4483section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4484input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4485example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4486in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4487
4488@menu
4489* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4490* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4491* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4492* Input Section:: Input section description
4493* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4494* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4495* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4496* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4497* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4498@end menu
4499
4500@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4501@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4502The full description of an output section looks like this:
4503@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4504@group
7e7d5768 4505@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4506 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4507 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4508 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4509 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4510 @{
4511 @var{output-section-command}
4512 @var{output-section-command}
4513 @dots{}
abc9061b 4514 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4515@end group
4516@end smallexample
4517
4518Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4519
4520The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4521name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4522The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4523the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4524The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4525
4526Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4527
4528@itemize @bullet
4529@item
4530a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4531@item
4532an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4533@item
4534data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4535@item
4536a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4537@end itemize
4538
4539@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4540@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4541@cindex name, section
4542@cindex section name
4543The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4544meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4545support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4546must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4547example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4548output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4549names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4550quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4551characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4552commas must be quoted.
4553
4554The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4555Discarding}.
4556
4557@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4558@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4559@cindex address, section
4560@cindex section address
4561The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4562address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4563is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4564
4565If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4566section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4567to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4568alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4569contained within the output section.
4570
4571The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4572
4573@itemize @bullet
4574@item
4575If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4576is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4577in that region.
4578
4579@item
4580If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4581regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4582section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4583be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4584
4585@item
4586If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4587the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4588counter.
4589@end itemize
4590
4591@noindent
4592For example:
4593
252b5132
RH
4594@smallexample
4595.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4596@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4597
252b5132
RH
4598@noindent
4599and
ea5cae92 4600
252b5132
RH
4601@smallexample
4602.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4603@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4604
252b5132
RH
4605@noindent
4606are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4607@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4608counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4609counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4610input sections.
252b5132
RH
4611
4612The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4613For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4614so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4615do something like this:
4616@smallexample
4617.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4618@end smallexample
4619@noindent
4620This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4621aligned upward to the specified value.
4622
4623Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4624location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4625sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4626
4627@node Input Section
36f63dca 4628@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4629@cindex input sections
4630@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4631The most common output section command is an input section description.
4632
4633The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4634You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4635in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4636map the input files into your memory layout.
4637
4638@menu
4639* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4640* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4641* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4642* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4643* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4644@end menu
4645
4646@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4647@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4648@cindex input section basics
4649An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4650by a list of section names in parentheses.
4651
4652The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4653describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4654
4655The most common input section description is to include all input
4656sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4657include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4658@smallexample
4659*(.text)
4660@end smallexample
4661@noindent
18625d54 4662Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4663@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4664of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4665match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4666example:
252b5132 4667@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4668EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4669@end smallexample
4670@noindent
4671will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4672and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4673placed inside the section list, for example:
4674@smallexample
b4346c09 4675*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4676@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4677@noindent
4678The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4679two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4680more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4681
4682There are two ways to include more than one section:
4683@smallexample
4684*(.text .rdata)
4685*(.text) *(.rdata)
4686@end smallexample
4687@noindent
4688The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4689@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4690first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4691they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4692@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4693@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4694
8f1732fc
AB
4695When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4696is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4697immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4698@smallexample
4699*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4700@end smallexample
4701@noindent
4702will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4703@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4704from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4705exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4706could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4707@smallexample
4708*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4709@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4710@noindent
4711Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4712before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4713all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4714@smallexample
4715EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4716@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 4717
252b5132
RH
4718You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4719You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4720needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4721@smallexample
4722data.o(.data)
4723@end smallexample
4724
ae17ab41
CM
4725To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4726of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4727
4728Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4729
4730@smallexample
4731@group
4732SECTIONS @{
4733 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4734 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4735@}
4736@end group
4737@end smallexample
4738
4739In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4740input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4741@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4742@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4743whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4744
967928e9
AM
4745You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4746matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4747with no whitespace around the colon.
4748
4749@table @samp
4750@item archive:file
4751matches file within archive
4752@item archive:
4753matches the whole archive
4754@item :file
4755matches file but not one in an archive
4756@end table
4757
4758Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4759wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4760single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4761@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4762within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4763also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4764other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4765from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4766command.
4767
252b5132
RH
4768If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4769the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4770commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4771@smallexample
4772data.o
4773@end smallexample
4774
967928e9
AM
4775When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4776and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
4777characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4778name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4779did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4780though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4781@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4782the archive search path.
4783
4784@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 4785@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
4786@cindex input section wildcards
4787@cindex wildcard file name patterns
4788@cindex file name wildcard patterns
4789@cindex section name wildcard patterns
4790In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4791name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4792
4793The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4794pattern for the file name.
4795
4796The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4797
4798@table @samp
4799@item *
4800matches any number of characters
4801@item ?
4802matches any single character
4803@item [@var{chars}]
4804matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4805character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4806@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4807@item \
4808quotes the following character
4809@end table
4810
4811When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
4812will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
4813Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
4814exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
4815@samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
4816a @samp{/} character.
4817
4818File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
4819specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
4820does not search directories to expand wildcards.
4821
4822If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
4823appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
4824will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
4825sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
4826@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
4827@smallexample
4828.data : @{ *(.data) @}
4829.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
4830@end smallexample
4831
bcaa7b3e 4832@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
4833Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
4834in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
4835this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
4836pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
4837@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
4838into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
4839
bcaa7b3e 4840@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
4841@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4842@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
4843alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
4844alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
4845needed.
bcaa7b3e 4846
02ecc8e9 4847@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
4848@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4849@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
4850numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
4851section name before placing them in the output file. In
4852@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
4853the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
4854@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 4855
bcaa7b3e
L
4856@cindex SORT
4857@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4858
4859When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
4860can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
4861
4862@enumerate
4863@item
4864@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 4865It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
4866sections have the same name.
4867@item
4868@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 4869It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
4870sections have the same alignment.
4871@item
c0065db7 4872@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
4873treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
4874@item
4875@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
4876is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
4877@item
4878All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
4879@end enumerate
4880
a05a5b64 4881When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 4882section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 4883takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
4884
4885If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 4886command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
4887treated as nested sorting command.
4888
4889@enumerate
4890@item
4891@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
4892@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
4893@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
4894@item
4895@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
4896@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
4897@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
4898@end enumerate
4899
4900If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 4901command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 4902
eda680f8 4903@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 4904@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
4905section sorting option.
4906
252b5132
RH
4907If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
4908@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
4909precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
4910
4911This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
4912files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
4913sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
4914The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
4915with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
4916linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
4917@smallexample
4918@group
4919SECTIONS @{
4920 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4921 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
4922 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4923 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
4924@}
4925@end group
4926@end smallexample
4927
4928@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 4929@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
4930@cindex common symbol placement
4931@cindex uninitialized data placement
4932A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
4933file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
4934linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
4935named @samp{COMMON}.
4936
4937You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
4938other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
4939particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
4940input files are placed in another section.
4941
4942In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
4943@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
4944@smallexample
4945.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
4946@end smallexample
4947
4948@cindex scommon section
4949@cindex small common symbols
4950Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
4951example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
4952symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
4953different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
4954the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
4955symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
4956to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
4957locations.
4958
4959@cindex [COMMON]
4960You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
4961notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
4962@samp{*(COMMON)}.
4963
4964@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 4965@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
4966@cindex KEEP
4967@cindex garbage collection
4968When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 4969it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
4970This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
4971with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 4972@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
4973
4974@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 4975@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
4976The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
4977to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
4978start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
4979@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
4980follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
4981@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
4982@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
4983All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
4984files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
4985
4986@smallexample
4987@group
4988SECTIONS @{
4989 outputa 0x10000 :
4990 @{
4991 all.o
4992 foo.o (.input1)
4993 @}
36f63dca
NC
4994@end group
4995@group
252b5132
RH
4996 outputb :
4997 @{
4998 foo.o (.input2)
4999 foo1.o (.input1)
5000 @}
36f63dca
NC
5001@end group
5002@group
252b5132
RH
5003 outputc :
5004 @{
5005 *(.input1)
5006 *(.input2)
5007 @}
5008@}
5009@end group
a1ab1d2a 5010@end smallexample
252b5132 5011
cbd0eecf
L
5012If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5013and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5014automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5015__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5016indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5017respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5018C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5019
252b5132 5020@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5021@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5022@cindex data
5023@cindex section data
5024@cindex output section data
5025@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5026@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5027@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5028@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5029@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5030You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5031@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5032an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5033parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5034value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5035counter.
5036
5037The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5038store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5039bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5040stored.
5041
5042For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5043of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5044@smallexample
5045BYTE(1)
5046LONG(addr)
5047@end smallexample
5048
5049When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5050same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5051target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5052@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5053@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5054
5055If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5056which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5057When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5058true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5059endianness of the first input object file.
5060
36f63dca 5061Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5062between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5063@smallexample
5064SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5065@end smallexample
5066whereas this will work:
5067@smallexample
5068SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5069@end smallexample
5070
252b5132
RH
5071@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5072@cindex holes, filling
5073@cindex unspecified memory
5074You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5075current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5076otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5077gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5078with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5079necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5080point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5081than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5082different parts of an output section.
5083
5084This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5085value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5086@smallexample
563e308f 5087FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5088@end smallexample
5089
5090The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5091section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5092part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5093entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5094precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5095expression.
252b5132
RH
5096
5097@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5098@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5099There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5100commands.
5101
5102@table @code
5103@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5104@cindex input filename symbols
5105@cindex filename symbols
5106@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5107The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5108The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5109file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5110the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5111
5112This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5113normally used for any other object file format.
5114
5115@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5116@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5117@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5118@item CONSTRUCTORS
5119When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5120unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5121destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5122arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5123automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5124For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5125linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5126@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5127ignored for other object file formats.
5128
5129The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5130constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5131Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5132the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5133first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5134of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5135compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5136formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5137@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5138the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5139destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5140@code{exit}.
5141
5142For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5143arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5144addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5145and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5146linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5147runtime code expects to see.
5148
5149@smallexample
5150 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5151 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5152 *(.ctors)
5153 LONG(0)
5154 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5155 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5156 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5157 *(.dtors)
5158 LONG(0)
5159 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5160@end smallexample
5161
5162If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5163which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5164are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5165are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5166command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5167@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5168@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5169@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5170
5171Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5172and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5173need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5174scripts.
5175
5176@end table
5177
5178@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5179@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5180@cindex discarding sections
5181@cindex sections, discarding
5182@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5183The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5184This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5185may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5186@smallexample
49c13adb 5187.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5188@end smallexample
5189@noindent
5190will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5191@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5192sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5193space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5194too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5195space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5196@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5197@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5198This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5199
a0976ea4 5200The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5201on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5202symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5203the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5204section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5205
5206@cindex /DISCARD/
5207The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5208input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5209section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5210
a2e098c3
NC
5211Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5212discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5213members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5214Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5215
252b5132 5216@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5217@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5218@cindex output section attributes
5219We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5220like this:
0c71d759 5221
252b5132 5222@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5223@group
7e7d5768 5224@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5225 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5226 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5227 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5228 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5229 @{
5230 @var{output-section-command}
5231 @var{output-section-command}
5232 @dots{}
562d3460 5233 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5234@end group
5235@end smallexample
0c71d759 5236
252b5132
RH
5237We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5238@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5239remaining section attributes.
5240
a1ab1d2a 5241@menu
252b5132
RH
5242* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5243* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5244* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5245* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5246* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5247* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5248* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5249* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5250@end menu
5251
5252@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5253@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5254Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5255parentheses. The following types are defined:
5256
5257@table @code
5258@item NOLOAD
5259The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5260loaded into memory when the program is run.
5261@item DSECT
5262@itemx COPY
5263@itemx INFO
5264@itemx OVERLAY
5265These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5266rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5267marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5268section when the program is run.
5269@end table
5270
5271@kindex NOLOAD
5272@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5273@cindex loading, preventing
5274The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5275the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5276the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5277@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5278need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5279@smallexample
5280@group
5281SECTIONS @{
5282 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5283 @dots{}
5284@}
5285@end group
5286@end smallexample
5287
5288@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5289@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5290@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5291@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5292@cindex load address
5293@cindex section load address
5294Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5295@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5296@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5297specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5298address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5299
ea5cae92
NC
5300The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5301specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5302takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5303load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5304region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5305
5306If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5307section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5308load address:
5309
5310@itemize @bullet
5311@item
5312If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5313the LMA address as well.
5314
5315@item
5316If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5317
5318@item
5319Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5320with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5321section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5322VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5323the last section in the located region.
5324
5325@item
5326If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5327that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5328
5329@item
5330If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5331section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5332@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5333
5334@cindex ROM initialized data
5335@cindex initialized data in ROM
5336This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5337example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5338called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5339@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5340even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5341uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5342defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5343counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5344
5345@smallexample
5346@group
5347SECTIONS
5348 @{
5349 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5350 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5351 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5352 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5353 .bss 0x3000 :
5354 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5355@}
5356@end group
5357@end smallexample
5358
5359The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5360this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5361the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5362how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5363script.
5364
5365@smallexample
5366@group
5367extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5368char *src = &_etext;
5369char *dst = &_data;
5370
ea5cae92
NC
5371/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5372while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5373 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5374
ea5cae92 5375/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5376for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5377 *dst = 0;
5378@end group
5379@end smallexample
5380
bbf115d3
L
5381@node Forced Output Alignment
5382@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5383@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5384@cindex forcing output section alignment
5385@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5386You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5387alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5388intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5389
7e7d5768
AM
5390@node Forced Input Alignment
5391@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5392@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5393@cindex forcing input section alignment
5394@cindex input section alignment
5395You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5396SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5397sections, whether larger or smaller.
5398
0c71d759
NC
5399@node Output Section Constraint
5400@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5401@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5402@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5403@cindex constraints on output sections
5404You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5405of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5406read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5407@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5408
252b5132 5409@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5410@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5411@kindex >@var{region}
5412@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5413@cindex memory regions and sections
5414You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5415using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5416
5417Here is a simple example:
5418@smallexample
5419@group
5420MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5421SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5422@end group
5423@end smallexample
5424
5425@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5426@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5427@kindex :@var{phdr}
5428@cindex section, assigning to program header
5429@cindex program headers and sections
5430You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5431using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5432one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5433assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5434@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5435linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5436
5437Here is a simple example:
5438@smallexample
5439@group
5440PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5441SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5442@end group
5443@end smallexample
5444
5445@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5446@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5447@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5448@cindex section fill pattern
5449@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5450You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5451@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5452(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5453within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5454alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5455necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5456of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5457an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5458fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5459other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5460pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5461expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5462
5463You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5464output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5465
5466Here is a simple example:
5467@smallexample
5468@group
563e308f 5469SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5470@end group
5471@end smallexample
5472
5473@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5474@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5475@kindex OVERLAY
5476@cindex overlays
5477An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5478are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5479the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5480copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5481required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5482can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5483than another.
5484
5485Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5486@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5487output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5488command is as follows:
5489@smallexample
5490@group
5491OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5492 @{
5493 @var{secname1}
5494 @{
5495 @var{output-section-command}
5496 @var{output-section-command}
5497 @dots{}
5498 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5499 @var{secname2}
5500 @{
5501 @var{output-section-command}
5502 @var{output-section-command}
5503 @dots{}
5504 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5505 @dots{}
abc9061b 5506 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5507@end group
5508@end smallexample
5509
5510Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5511section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5512section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5513those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5514except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5515sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5516
abc9061b
CC
5517The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5518the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5519
252b5132
RH
5520The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5521addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5522memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5523whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5524and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5525and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5526
56dd11f0
NC
5527If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5528references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5529the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5530sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5531@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5532
5533For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5534provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5535defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5536@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5537the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5538within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5539symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5540
5541At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5542the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5543
5544Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5545@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5546@smallexample
5547@group
5548 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5549 @{
5550 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5551 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5552 @}
5553@end group
5554@end smallexample
5555@noindent
5556This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5557address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5558@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5559following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5560@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5561@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5562
5563C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5564like the following.
5565
5566@smallexample
5567@group
5568 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5569 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5570 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5571@end group
5572@end smallexample
5573
5574Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5575everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5576example could have been written identically as follows.
5577
5578@smallexample
5579@group
5580 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5581 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5582 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5583 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5584 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5585 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5586 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5587@end group
5588@end smallexample
5589
5590@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5591@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5592@kindex MEMORY
5593@cindex memory regions
5594@cindex regions of memory
5595@cindex allocating memory
5596@cindex discontinuous memory
5597The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5598memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5599
5600The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5601memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5602may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5603can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5604set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5605regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5606around to fit into the available regions.
5607
127fcdff
AB
5608A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5609however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5610specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5611@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5612@smallexample
5613@group
a1ab1d2a 5614MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5615 @{
5616 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5617 @dots{}
5618 @}
5619@end group
5620@end smallexample
5621
5622The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5623region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5624Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5625with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5626must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5627add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5628command.
252b5132
RH
5629
5630@cindex memory region attributes
5631The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5632whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5633not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5634@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5635section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5636the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5637them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5638
5639The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5640@table @samp
5641@item R
5642Read-only section
5643@item W
5644Read/write section
5645@item X
5646Executable section
5647@item A
5648Allocatable section
5649@item I
5650Initialized section
5651@item L
5652Same as @samp{I}
5653@item !
c09e9a8c 5654Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5655@end table
5656
81c688d5 5657If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5658@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5659attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5660unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5661not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5662string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5663or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5664the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5665
5666@kindex ORIGIN =
5667@kindex o =
5668@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5669The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5670the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5671cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5672abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5673@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
5674
5675@kindex LENGTH =
5676@kindex len =
5677@kindex l =
5678The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5679region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
5680be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5681@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
5682
5683In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5684available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5685and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5686linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5687is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5688or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5689explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5690region.
5691
5692@smallexample
5693@group
a1ab1d2a 5694MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5695 @{
5696 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5697 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5698 @}
5699@end group
5700@end smallexample
5701
5702Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5703specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5704@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5705a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5706output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5707was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5708the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5709output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5710region, the linker will issue an error message.
5711
3ec57632 5712It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 5713expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
5714@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5715
5716@smallexample
5717@group
c0065db7 5718 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
5719@end group
5720@end smallexample
5721
252b5132
RH
5722@node PHDRS
5723@section PHDRS Command
5724@kindex PHDRS
5725@cindex program headers
5726@cindex ELF program headers
5727@cindex program segments
5728@cindex segments, ELF
5729The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5730@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5731loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5732program with the @samp{-p} option.
5733
5734When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5735reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5736program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5737This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5738interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5739
5740The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5741in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5742precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5743the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5744not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5745
5746The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5747generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5748ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5749
5750This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5751@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5752
5753@smallexample
5754@group
5755PHDRS
5756@{
5757 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5758 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5759@}
5760@end group
5761@end smallexample
5762
5763The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5764of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5765header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5766with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
5767must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5768is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
5769
5770Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5771system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5772specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5773sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5774attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5775Section Phdr}.
5776
5777It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5778merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5779repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5780contain the section.
5781
5782If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5783then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5784not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5785convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5786placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5787default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5788segment at all.
5789
5790@kindex FILEHDR
5791@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 5792You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
5793the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5794The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5795file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 5796include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
5797segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5798these keywords.
252b5132
RH
5799
5800The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5801value of the keyword.
5802
5803@table @asis
5804@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5805Indicates an unused program header.
5806
5807@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
5808Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
5809the file.
5810
5811@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
5812Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
5813
5814@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
5815Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
5816found.
5817
5818@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
5819Indicates a segment holding note information.
5820
5821@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
5822A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
5823ABI.
5824
5825@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
5826Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
5827
1a9ccd70
NC
5828@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
5829Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
5830
252b5132
RH
5831@item @var{expression}
5832An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
5833be used for types not defined above.
5834@end table
5835
5836You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
5837in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
5838@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
5839Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
5840output section attribute.
5841
5842The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
5843which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
5844explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
5845an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
5846header.
5847
5848Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
5849headers used on a native ELF system.
5850
5851@example
5852@group
5853PHDRS
5854@{
5855 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
5856 interp PT_INTERP ;
5857 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
5858 data PT_LOAD ;
5859 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
5860@}
5861
5862SECTIONS
5863@{
5864 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
5865 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
5866 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
5867 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
5868 @dots{}
5869 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
5870 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
5871 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
5872 @dots{}
5873@}
5874@end group
5875@end example
5876
5877@node VERSION
5878@section VERSION Command
5879@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
5880@cindex symbol versions
5881@cindex version script
5882@cindex versions of symbols
5883The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
5884only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
5885symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
5886a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
5887shared library.
5888
5889You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
5890you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
5891also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
5892
5893The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
5894@smallexample
5895VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
5896@end smallexample
5897
5898The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
5899Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
5900version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
5901version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
5902version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
5903scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
5904library.
5905
5906The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
5907examples.
5908
5909@smallexample
5910VERS_1.1 @{
5911 global:
5912 foo1;
5913 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
5914 old*;
5915 original*;
5916 new*;
252b5132
RH
5917@};
5918
5919VERS_1.2 @{
5920 foo2;
5921@} VERS_1.1;
5922
5923VERS_2.0 @{
5924 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 5925 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 5926 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
5927 "f(int, double)";
5928 @};
252b5132
RH
5929@} VERS_1.2;
5930@end smallexample
5931
5932This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
5933version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
5934The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
5935a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
5936of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
5937symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
5938is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
5939in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
5940However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
5941name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
5942
5943Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
5944depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
5945to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
5946
5947Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
5948depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
5949and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
5950
5951When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
5952specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
5953unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 5954unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
5955somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
5956wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
5957wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
5958set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
5959ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
5960
5961The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
5962they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
5963could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
5964However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
5965
0f6bf451 5966Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
5967in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
5968symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
5969won't.
5970
5971@smallexample
7c9c73be 5972@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 5973@end smallexample
6b9b879a 5974
252b5132
RH
5975When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
5976symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
5977requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
5978shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
5979loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
5980linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
5981application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
5982way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
5983all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
5984search for each symbol reference.
5985
5986The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
5987doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
5988that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
5989functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
5990the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
5991required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
5992that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
5993versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
5994the libraries being used with the application are too old.
5995
5996There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
5997first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
5998source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
5999script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6000maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6001@smallexample
6002__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6003@end smallexample
6004@noindent
6005in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6006be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6007The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6008@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6009takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6010
6011The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6012function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6013an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6014version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6015linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6016
6017To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6018source file. Here is an example:
6019
6020@smallexample
6021__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6022__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6023__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6024__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6025@end smallexample
6026
6027In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6028unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6029example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6030@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6031
6032When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6033some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6034this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6035@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6036declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6037you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6038
6039If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6040within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6041(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6042specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6043
cb840a31
L
6044You can also specify the language in the version script:
6045
6046@smallexample
6047VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6048@end smallexample
6049
c0065db7 6050The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6051The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6052demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6053patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6054@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6055
86043bbb
MM
6056Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6057described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6058or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6059the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6060whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6061cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6062might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6063should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6064expect when you upgrade.
6065
252b5132
RH
6066@node Expressions
6067@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6068@cindex expressions
6069@cindex arithmetic
6070The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6071that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6072expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6073host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6074
6075You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6076
6077The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6078expressions.
6079
6080@menu
6081* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6082* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6083* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6084* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6085* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6086* Operators:: Operators
6087* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6088* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6089* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6090@end menu
6091
6092@node Constants
6093@subsection Constants
6094@cindex integer notation
6095@cindex constants in linker scripts
6096All constants are integers.
6097
6098As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6099octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6100hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6101@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6102@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6103value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6104
6105@cindex scaled integers
6106@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6107@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6108@cindex suffixes for integers
6109@cindex integer suffixes
6110In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6111constant by
6112@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6113@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6114@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6115@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6116@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6117@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6118@tex
6119${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6120@end tex
6121@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6122respectively. For example, the following
6123all refer to the same quantity:
6124
252b5132 6125@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6126_fourk_1 = 4K;
6127_fourk_2 = 4096;
6128_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6129_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6130@end smallexample
6131
8a308ae8
NC
6132Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6133conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6134
0c71d759
NC
6135@node Symbolic Constants
6136@subsection Symbolic Constants
6137@cindex symbolic constants
6138@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6139It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6140the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6141
6142@table @code
6143@item MAXPAGESIZE
6144@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6145The target's maximum page size.
6146
6147@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6148@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6149The target's default page size.
6150@end table
6151
6152So for example:
6153
6154@smallexample
9d5777a3 6155 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6156@end smallexample
6157
6158will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6159supported by the target.
6160
252b5132
RH
6161@node Symbols
6162@subsection Symbol Names
6163@cindex symbol names
6164@cindex names
6165@cindex quoted symbol names
6166@kindex "
6167Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6168and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6169Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6170specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6171keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6172@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6173"SECTION" = 9;
6174"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6175@end smallexample
6176
6177Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6178to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6179whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6180
ecca9871
L
6181@node Orphan Sections
6182@subsection Orphan Sections
6183@cindex orphan
6184Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6185are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6186script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6187output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6188in which to place the orphaned input section.
6189
6190If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6191an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6192placed at the end of that output section.
6193
6194If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6195sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6196name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6197orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6198one new output section.
6199
6200If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6201then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6202in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6203linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6204attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6205sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6206support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6207
a05a5b64
TP
6208The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6209(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6210output sections an orphan is placed in.
6211
252b5132
RH
6212@node Location Counter
6213@subsection The Location Counter
6214@kindex .
6215@cindex dot
6216@cindex location counter
6217@cindex current output location
6218The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6219current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6220location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6221within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6222anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6223
6224@cindex holes
6225Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6226moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6227location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6228and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6229doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6230
6231@smallexample
6232SECTIONS
6233@{
6234 output :
6235 @{
6236 file1(.text)
6237 . = . + 1000;
6238 file2(.text)
6239 . += 1000;
6240 file3(.text)
563e308f 6241 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6242@}
6243@end smallexample
6244@noindent
6245In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6246located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6247followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6248@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6249@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6250specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6251
5c6bbab8
NC
6252@cindex dot inside sections
6253Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6254current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6255statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6256absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6257however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6258not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6259
6260@smallexample
6261SECTIONS
6262@{
6263 . = 0x100
6264 .text: @{
6265 *(.text)
6266 . = 0x200
6267 @}
6268 . = 0x500
6269 .data: @{
6270 *(.data)
6271 . += 0x600
6272 @}
6273@}
6274@end smallexample
6275
6276The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6277and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6278the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6279much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6280move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6281and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6282the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6283the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6284
b5666f2f
AM
6285@cindex dot outside sections
6286Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6287output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6288needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6289
6290@smallexample
6291SECTIONS
6292@{
6293 start_of_text = . ;
6294 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6295 end_of_text = . ;
6296
6297 start_of_data = . ;
6298 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6299 end_of_data = . ;
6300@}
6301@end smallexample
6302
6303If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6304not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6305between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6306should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6307blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6308the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6309sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6310statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6311special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6312place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6313as follows:
6314
6315@smallexample
6316SECTIONS
6317@{
6318 start_of_text = . ;
6319 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6320 end_of_text = . ;
6321
6322 start_of_data = . ;
6323 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6324 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6325 end_of_data = . ;
6326@}
6327@end smallexample
6328
6329This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6330@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6331placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6332assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6333a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6334section. So you could write:
6335
6336@smallexample
6337SECTIONS
6338@{
6339 start_of_text = . ;
6340 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6341 end_of_text = . ;
6342
6343 . = . ;
6344 start_of_data = . ;
6345 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6346 end_of_data = . ;
6347@}
6348@end smallexample
6349
6350Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6351@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6352
252b5132
RH
6353@need 2000
6354@node Operators
6355@subsection Operators
6356@cindex operators for arithmetic
6357@cindex arithmetic operators
6358@cindex precedence in expressions
6359The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6360the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6361@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6362@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6363@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6364@smallexample
6365precedence associativity Operators Notes
6366(highest)
63671 left ! - ~ (1)
63682 left * / %
63693 left + -
63704 left >> <<
63715 left == != > < <= >=
63726 left &
63737 left |
63748 left &&
63759 left ||
637610 right ? :
637711 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6378(lowest)
6379@end smallexample
6380Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6381(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6382(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6383@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6384@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6385@tex
6386\vskip \baselineskip
6387%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6388\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6389\hrule
6390\halign
6391{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6392height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6393&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6394height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6395\noalign{\hrule}
6396height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6397&highest&&&&&\cr
6398% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6399&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6400&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6401&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6402&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6403&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6404&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6405&7&&left&&|&\cr
6406&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6407&9&&left&&||&\cr
6408&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6409&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6410&lowest&&&&&\cr
6411height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6412\hrule}
6413@end tex
6414@iftex
6415{
6416@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6417@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6418@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6419}
6420@end iftex
6421@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6422
6423@node Evaluation
6424@subsection Evaluation
6425@cindex lazy evaluation
6426@cindex expression evaluation order
6427The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6428an expression when absolutely necessary.
6429
6430The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6431address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6432regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6433as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6434
6435However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6436until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6437other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6438for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6439
6440The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6441assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6442allocation.
6443
6444Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6445@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6446
6447If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6448available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6449following
6450@smallexample
6451@group
6452SECTIONS
6453 @{
a1ab1d2a 6454 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6455 @{ *(.text) @}
6456 @}
6457@end group
6458@end smallexample
6459@noindent
6460will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6461address}.
6462
6463@node Expression Section
6464@subsection The Section of an Expression
6465@cindex expression sections
6466@cindex absolute expressions
6467@cindex relative expressions
6468@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6469@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6470@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6471Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6472relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6473using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6474value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6475symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6476operations.
6477
abf4be64
AM
6478Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6479section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6480address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6481@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6482functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6483One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6484(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6485differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6486versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6487section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6488Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6489absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6490given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6491everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6492
6493In the following simple example,
252b5132 6494
7542af2a
AM
6495@smallexample
6496@group
6497SECTIONS
6498 @{
6499 . = 0x100;
6500 __executable_start = 0x100;
6501 .data :
6502 @{
6503 . = 0x10;
6504 __data_start = 0x10;
6505 *(.data)
6506 @}
6507 @dots{}
6508 @}
6509@end group
6510@end smallexample
252b5132 6511
7542af2a
AM
6512both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6513address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6514@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6515section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6516
5c3049d2
AM
6517For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6518addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6519
6520@itemize @bullet
6521@item
c05f749e
AM
6522Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6523operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6524absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6525@item
7542af2a
AM
6526Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6527relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6528and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6529@item
c05f749e
AM
6530Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6531in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6532address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6533before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6534@end itemize
6535
6536The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6537
6538@itemize @bullet
6539@item
6540An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6541@item
6542The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6543@item
9bc8bb33 6544The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6545relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6546(after above conversions) is also a number when
6547@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6548but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6549@item
6550The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6551relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6552section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6553@item
6554The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6555conversions) is an absolute address.
6556@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6557
6558You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6559to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6560create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6561section @samp{.data}:
6562@smallexample
6563SECTIONS
6564 @{
6565 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6566 @}
6567@end smallexample
6568@noindent
6569If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6570@samp{.data} section.
6571
7542af2a
AM
6572Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6573particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6574
252b5132
RH
6575@node Builtin Functions
6576@subsection Builtin Functions
6577@cindex functions in expressions
6578The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6579use in linker script expressions.
6580
6581@table @code
6582@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6583@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6584@cindex expression, absolute
6585Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6586of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6587value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6588normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6589
6590@item ADDR(@var{section})
6591@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6592@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6593Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6594script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6595the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6596@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6597@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6598the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6599@smallexample
6600@group
6601SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6602 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6603 @{
252b5132
RH
6604 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6605 @dots{}
6606 @}
6607 .output :
6608 @{
6609 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6610 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6611 @}
6612@dots{} @}
6613@end group
6614@end smallexample
6615
876f4090
NS
6616@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6617@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6618@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6619@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6620@cindex round up location counter
6621@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6622@cindex round up expression
6623@cindex align expression
6624Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6625to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6626doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6627arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6628expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6629equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6630
6631Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6632next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6633variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6634input sections:
252b5132
RH
6635@smallexample
6636@group
6637SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6638 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6639 *(.data)
6640 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6641 @}
6642@dots{} @}
6643@end group
6644@end smallexample
6645@noindent
6646The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6647a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6648a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6649of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6650
6651The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6652
362c1d1a
NS
6653@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6654@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6655@cindex section alignment
6656Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6657been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6658evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6659the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6660value in that section.
6661@smallexample
6662@group
6663SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6664 .output @{
6665 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6666 @dots{}
6667 @}
6668@dots{} @}
6669@end group
6670@end smallexample
6671
252b5132
RH
6672@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6673@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6674This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6675scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6676section.
6677
2d20f7bf
JJ
6678@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6679@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6680This is equivalent to either
6681@smallexample
6682(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6683@end smallexample
6684or
6685@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
6686(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6687 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
6688@end smallexample
6689@noindent
6690depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6691for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6692@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6693If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6694memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6695bytes in the on-disk file.
6696
6697This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6698any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6699@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
6700be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6701running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6702that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6703page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
6704
6705@noindent
6706Example:
6707@smallexample
6708 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6709@end smallexample
6710
6711@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6712@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6713This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6714evaluation purposes.
6715
6716@smallexample
6717 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6718@end smallexample
6719
a4f5ad88
JJ
6720@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6721@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6722This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 6723@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6724When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6725does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
6726@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6727argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6728script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
6729@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6730padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6731section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6732
6733@smallexample
6734 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6735@end smallexample
6736
252b5132
RH
6737@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6738@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6739@cindex symbol defaults
6740Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
6741defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6742return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
6743default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6744shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6745the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6746existed, its value is preserved:
6747
6748@smallexample
6749@group
6750SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6751 .text : @{
6752 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6753 @dots{}
6754 @}
6755 @dots{}
6756@}
6757@end group
6758@end smallexample
6759
3ec57632
NC
6760@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6761@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6762Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6763
252b5132
RH
6764@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6765@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6766@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 6767Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
6768Section LMA}).
6769
2e53f7d6
NC
6770@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6771@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6772Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6773@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6774
252b5132
RH
6775@kindex MAX
6776@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6777Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6778
6779@kindex MIN
6780@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6781Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6782
6783@item NEXT(@var{exp})
6784@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6785@cindex unallocated address, next
6786Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6787This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6788use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6789output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6790
3ec57632
NC
6791@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6792@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6793Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6794
ba916c8a
MM
6795@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6796@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6797Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
6798value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6799@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6800will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6801can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 6802``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
6803name.
6804
252b5132
RH
6805@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6806@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
6807@cindex section size
6808Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6809been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6810evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6811@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
6812@smallexample
6813@group
6814SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6815 .output @{
6816 .start = . ;
6817 @dots{}
6818 .end = . ;
6819 @}
6820 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
6821 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
6822@dots{} @}
6823@end group
6824@end smallexample
6825
6826@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
6827@itemx sizeof_headers
6828@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
6829@cindex header size
6830Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
6831information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
6832this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
6833choose, to facilitate paging.
6834
6835@cindex not enough room for program headers
6836@cindex program headers, not enough room
6837When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
6838@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
6839number of program headers before it has determined all the section
6840addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
6841additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
6842room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
6843the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
6844script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
6845you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
6846command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
6847@end table
6848
6849@node Implicit Linker Scripts
6850@section Implicit Linker Scripts
6851@cindex implicit linker scripts
6852If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
6853an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
6854linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
6855linker will report an error.
6856
6857An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
6858
6859Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
6860assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
6861commands.
6862
6863Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
6864at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
6865read. This can affect archive searching.
6866
6867@ifset GENERIC
6868@node Machine Dependent
6869@chapter Machine Dependent Features
6870
6871@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
6872@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
6873sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
6874functionality are not listed.
6875
6876@menu
36f63dca
NC
6877@ifset H8300
6878* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
6879@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
6880@ifset M68HC11
6881* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
6882@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
6883@ifset ARM
6884* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
6885@end ifset
6886@ifset HPPA
6887* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
6888@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
6889@ifset M68K
6890* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
6891@end ifset
833794fc
MR
6892@ifset MIPS
6893* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
6894@end ifset
3c3bdf30 6895@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 6896* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 6897@end ifset
2469cfa2 6898@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 6899* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 6900@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
6901@ifset NDS32
6902* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
6903@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
6904@ifset NIOSII
6905* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
6906@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
6907@ifset POWERPC
6908* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
6909@end ifset
6910@ifset POWERPC64
6911* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
6912@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
6913@ifset S/390
6914* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
6915@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
6916@ifset SPU
6917* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
6918@end ifset
74459f0e 6919@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 6920* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 6921@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
6922@ifset WIN32
6923* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
6924@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
6925@ifset XTENSA
6926* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
6927@end ifset
252b5132
RH
6928@end menu
6929@end ifset
6930
252b5132
RH
6931@ifset H8300
6932@ifclear GENERIC
6933@raisesections
6934@end ifclear
6935
6936@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 6937@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
6938
6939@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 6940For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
6941you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
6942
6943@table @emph
6944@cindex relaxing on H8/300
6945@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 6946@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
6947targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
6948program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
6949respectively.
6950
6951@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
6952@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 6953@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 6954@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
6955sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
6956page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
6957(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
6958@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
6959top page of memory).
1502569c 6960
81f5558e
NC
6961@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
6962indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
6963displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
6964the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
6965@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
6966whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
6967range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
6968
1502569c 6969@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 6970@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 6971biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 6972which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
6973page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
6974(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 6975@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
6976the top page of memory).
6977
6978@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
6979@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
698032 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
6981changes them to use 16 bit address form.
6982(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 6983@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 6984the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
6985@end table
6986
6987@ifclear GENERIC
6988@lowersections
6989@end ifclear
6990@end ifset
6991
36f63dca 6992@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 6993@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 6994@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
6995@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
6996@node Renesas
6997@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 6998
c2dcd04e
NC
6999@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7000H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7001options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7002@end ifset
7003@end ifclear
7004
36f63dca
NC
7005@ifset ARM
7006@ifclear GENERIC
7007@raisesections
7008@end ifclear
7009
93fd0973
SC
7010@ifset M68HC11
7011@ifclear GENERIC
7012@raisesections
7013@end ifclear
7014
7015@node M68HC11/68HC12
7016@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7017
7018@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7019
7020@subsection Linker Relaxation
7021
7022For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7023optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7024
7025@table @emph
7026@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7027@item relaxing address modes
7028@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7029targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7030program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7031respectively.
7032
7033@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7034transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7035page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7036
7037@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7038When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7039of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7040addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7041@code{bset} instructions.
7042
7043@end table
7044
7045@subsection Trampoline Generation
7046
7047@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7048@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7049For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7050call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7051will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7052trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7053case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7054point to the function trampoline.
7055
7056@ifclear GENERIC
7057@lowersections
7058@end ifclear
7059@end ifset
7060
36f63dca 7061@node ARM
3674e28a 7062@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7063
7064@cindex ARM interworking support
7065@kindex --support-old-code
7066For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7067between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7068been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7069line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7070libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7071option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7072given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7073which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7074the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7075non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7076
7077@cindex thumb entry point
7078@cindex entry point, thumb
7079@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7080The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7081@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7082But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7083branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7084executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7085
ce11ba6c
KT
7086@cindex PE import table prefixing
7087@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7088The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7089the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7090element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7091import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7092
e489d0ae
PB
7093@cindex BE8
7094@kindex --be8
7095The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7096executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7097objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7098option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7099little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7100
3674e28a
PB
7101@cindex TARGET1
7102@kindex --target1-rel
7103@kindex --target1-abs
7104The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7105@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7106or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7107and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7108
7109@cindex TARGET2
7110@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7111The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7112@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7113meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7114@table @samp
7115@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7116@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7117@item abs
7118@samp{R_ARM_ABS32} (arm*-*-symbianelf)
3674e28a
PB
7119@item got-rel
7120@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7121@end table
7122
319850b4
JB
7123@cindex FIX_V4BX
7124@kindex --fix-v4bx
7125The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7126specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7127interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7128also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7129
7130In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7131linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7132@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7133
7134In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7135relocations are ignored.
7136
845b51d6
PB
7137@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7138@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7139Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7140relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7141
7142@smallexample
7143TST rM, #1
7144MOVEQ PC, rM
7145BX Rn
7146@end smallexample
7147
7148This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7149and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7150condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7151
33bfe774
JB
7152@cindex USE_BLX
7153@kindex --use-blx
7154The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7155BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7156situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7157code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7158each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7159
7160This option is enabled implicitly for SymbianOS, so there is no need to
7161specify it if you are using that target.
7162
c6dd86c6
JB
7163@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7164@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7165The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7166bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7167instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7168to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7169the support code can read the intended values.
7170
7171The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7172intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7173and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7174intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7175full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7176you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7177
7178If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7179enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7180@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7181mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7182vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7183@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7184
7185If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7186potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7187such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7188first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7189instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7190the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7191are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7192
2de70689
MGD
7193@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7194@kindex --fix-arm1176
7195@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7196The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7197in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7198are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7199unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7200
9d5777a3 7201Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7202Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7203http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7204
a504d23a
LA
7205@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7206@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7207
7208The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7209workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7210the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7211off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7212the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7213core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7214integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7215VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7216
7217The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7218necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7219
7220The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7221@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7222STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7223linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7224@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7225
7226If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7227potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7228such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7229replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7230branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7231then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7232
7233The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7234the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7235
7236The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7237they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7238there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7239occurs.
7240
7241The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7242PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7243large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7244cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7245occurs.
7246
bf21ed78
MS
7247@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7248@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7249The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7250warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7251enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7252linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7253using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7254not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7255
7256@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7257@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7258The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7259warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7260@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7261linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7262using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7263
726150b7
NC
7264@cindex PIC_VENEER
7265@kindex --pic-veneer
7266The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7267ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7268is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7269@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7270
7271@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7272@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7273The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7274code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7275perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7276placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7277controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7278The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7279duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7280group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7281code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7282where they should be placed.
7283
7284The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7285@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7286placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7287branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7288placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7289value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7290exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7291A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7292linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7293from the input sections.
7294
7295The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7296@samp{N = +1}.
7297
1a51c1a4
NC
7298Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7299only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7300otherwise.
7301
1db37fe6
YG
7302@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7303@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7304@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7305The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7306
7307The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7308
68fcca92
JW
7309@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7310@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7311@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7312The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7313
7314Please contact ARM for further details.
7315
1db37fe6
YG
7316@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7317@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7318@cindex Merging exidx entries
7319The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7320
7321@kindex --long-plt
7322@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7323The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7324which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7325entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7326
1f56df9d
JW
7327@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7328@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7329The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7330link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7331
4ba2ef8f
TP
7332@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7333All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7334Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7335@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7336veneers in memory.
7337
54ddd295
TP
7338@kindex --cmse-implib
7339@cindex Secure gateway import library
7340The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7341specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7342secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7343executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7344
0955507f
TP
7345@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7346@cindex Input import library
7347The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7348must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7349given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7350in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7351@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7352library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7353library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7354for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7355specified.
7356
36f63dca
NC
7357@ifclear GENERIC
7358@lowersections
7359@end ifclear
7360@end ifset
7361
7362@ifset HPPA
7363@ifclear GENERIC
7364@raisesections
7365@end ifclear
7366
7367@node HPPA ELF32
7368@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7369@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7370@kindex --multi-subspace
7371When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7372import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7373The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7374stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7375multiple sub-spaces.
7376
7377@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7378@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7379Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7380stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7381@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7382sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7383a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7384the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7385conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7386prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7387A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7388branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7389@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7390@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7391detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7392positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7393
7394Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7395single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7396create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7397large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7398
7399@ifclear GENERIC
7400@lowersections
7401@end ifclear
7402@end ifset
7403
7fb9f789
NC
7404@ifset M68K
7405@ifclear GENERIC
7406@raisesections
7407@end ifclear
7408
7409@node M68K
7410@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7411
7412@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7413@kindex --got=@var{type}
7414The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7415The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7416@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7417the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7418@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7419entries only at non-negative offsets.
7420@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7421entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7422support such GOTs.
7423@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7424output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7425file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7426files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7427
7428@ifclear GENERIC
7429@lowersections
7430@end ifclear
7431@end ifset
7432
833794fc
MR
7433@ifset MIPS
7434@ifclear GENERIC
7435@raisesections
7436@end ifclear
7437
7438@node MIPS
7439@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7440
7441@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7442@kindex --insn32
7443@kindex --no-insn32
7444The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7445microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7446in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7447used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7448or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7449including 16-bit ones where possible.
7450
8b10b0b3
MR
7451@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7452@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7453@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7454The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7455control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7456@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7457relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7458calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7459relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7460instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7461or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7462the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7463
833794fc
MR
7464@ifclear GENERIC
7465@lowersections
7466@end ifclear
7467@end ifset
7468
36f63dca
NC
7469@ifset MMIX
7470@ifclear GENERIC
7471@raisesections
7472@end ifclear
7473
7474@node MMIX
7475@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7476For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7477@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7478understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7479can translate between the two formats.
7480
7481There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7482Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7483registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7484equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7485@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7486global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7487this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7488symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7489
7a2de473
HPN
7490Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7491@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7492The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7493of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7494
7495Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7496are left out from an mmo file.
7497
7498@ifclear GENERIC
7499@lowersections
7500@end ifclear
7501@end ifset
7502
7503@ifset MSP430
7504@ifclear GENERIC
7505@raisesections
7506@end ifclear
7507
7508@node MSP430
7509@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7510For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7511will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7512just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7513
7514@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7515The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7516
7517@table @code
7518@item @samp{.vectors}
7519Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7520
7521@item @samp{.bootloader}
7522Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7523in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7524
7525@item @samp{.infomem}
7526Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7527this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7528
c0065db7 7529@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7530This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7531in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7532
7533@item @samp{.noinit}
7534Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7535
c0065db7 7536The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7537@end table
7538
7ef3addb
JL
7539@table @option
7540@cindex MSP430 Options
7541@kindex --code-region
7542@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7543This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7544argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7545using this option.
7546
7547@kindex --data-region
7548@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7549This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7550[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7551for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7552
7553@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7554@item --disable-sec-transformation
7555Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7556and @code{--data-region} options.
7557This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7558wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7559not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7560@end table
7561
36f63dca
NC
7562@ifclear GENERIC
7563@lowersections
7564@end ifclear
7565@end ifset
7566
35c08157
KLC
7567@ifset NDS32
7568@ifclear GENERIC
7569@raisesections
7570@end ifclear
7571
7572@node NDS32
7573@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7574@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7575For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7576relaxes objects according to these options.
7577
7578@table @code
7579@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7580Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7581
7582@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7583Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7584
7585@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7586Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7587
7588@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7589Export the EX9 table after linking.
7590
7591@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7592Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7593
7594@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7595Update the existing EX9 table.
7596
7597@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7598Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7599
7600@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7601Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7602
7603@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7604Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7605
7606@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7607Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7608@end table
7609
7610@ifclear GENERIC
7611@lowersections
7612@end ifclear
7613@end ifset
7614
78058a5e
SL
7615@ifset NIOSII
7616@ifclear GENERIC
7617@raisesections
7618@end ifclear
7619
7620@node Nios II
7621@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7622@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7623@kindex --relax on Nios II
7624
7625Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7626transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7627which may result in @command{ld} giving
7628@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7629The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7630trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7631outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7632trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7633be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7634larger than 256MB.
7635
7636The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7637is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7638@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7639locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7640source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7641register as a temporary.
7642
7643Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7644relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7645option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7646
7647@ifclear GENERIC
7648@lowersections
7649@end ifclear
7650@end ifset
7651
2a60a7a8
AM
7652@ifset POWERPC
7653@ifclear GENERIC
7654@raisesections
7655@end ifclear
7656
7657@node PowerPC ELF32
7658@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7659@cindex PowerPC long branches
7660@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7661Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7662displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7663@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7664@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7665the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7666section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
7667section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7668@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7669both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7670considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
7671
7672@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7673@table @option
7674@cindex PowerPC PLT
7675@kindex --bss-plt
7676@item --bss-plt
7677Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7678generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7679the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7680writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7681@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7682PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7683compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7684BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7685
016687f8
AM
7686@kindex --secure-plt
7687@item --secure-plt
7688@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7689@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7690when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7691layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7692style BSS PLT.
7693
2a60a7a8
AM
7694@cindex PowerPC GOT
7695@kindex --sdata-got
7696@item --sdata-got
7697The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7698sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7699@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7700section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7701@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7702@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7703@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7704@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7705PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7706pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7707GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7708really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7709
7710@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7711@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7712@item --emit-stub-syms
7713This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7714symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7715
7716@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7717@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7718@item --no-tls-optimize
7719PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7720sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7721disable the optimization.
7722@end table
7723
7724@ifclear GENERIC
7725@lowersections
7726@end ifclear
7727@end ifset
7728
7729@ifset POWERPC64
7730@ifclear GENERIC
7731@raisesections
7732@end ifclear
7733
7734@node PowerPC64 ELF64
7735@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7736
7737@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7738@table @option
7739@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7740@kindex --stub-group-size
7741@item --stub-group-size
7742Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7743by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7744@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7745sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7746a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7747the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7748conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7749prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7750A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7751branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7752@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7753@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7754detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7755positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7756
7757Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7758single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7759create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7760large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7761
7762@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
7763@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7764@item --emit-stub-syms
7765This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7766symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7767
7768@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
7769@kindex --dotsyms
7770@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
7771@item --dotsyms
7772@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
7773These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
7774in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
7775function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
7776code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
7777properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
7778to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
7779@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
7780dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
7781feature.
7782
7ae4ea7d
AM
7783@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
7784@kindex --save-restore-funcs
7785@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
7786@item --save-restore-funcs
7787@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
7788These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
7789provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
7790@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
7791function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
7792link.
7793
2a60a7a8
AM
7794@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
7795@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7796@item --no-tls-optimize
7797PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7798sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7799disable the optimization.
7800
7c9cf415
AM
7801@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
7802@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
7803@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
7804@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
7805@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
7806@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
7807@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 7808These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
7809stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
7810an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
7811@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
7812stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
7813generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
7814__tls_get_addr_opt.
7815Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
7816much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
7817an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
7818will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
7819@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
7820and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
7821this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
7822Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 7823@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 7824register saves.
7c9cf415 7825
2a60a7a8
AM
7826@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
7827@kindex --no-opd-optimize
7828@item --no-opd-optimize
7829PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
7830corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 7831the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
7832Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
7833
7834@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
7835@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
7836@item --non-overlapping-opd
7837Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
7838@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
7839the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
7840entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
7841
7842@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
7843@kindex --no-toc-optimize
7844@item --no-toc-optimize
7845PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
7846entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
7847reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
7848marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
7849marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
7850relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
7851unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
7852reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
7853discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
7854reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
7855code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
7856optimization.
7857
d882c988
AM
7858@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
7859@kindex --no-inline-optimize
7860@item --no-inline-optimize
7861PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
7862marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
7863@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
7864a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
7865locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
7866disables that optimization.
7867
2a60a7a8
AM
7868@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
7869@kindex --no-multi-toc
7870@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
7871If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
7872@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
7873where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
7874entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
7875total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
7876grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
7877TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
7878calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
7879help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
788064K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
7881Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
7882
7883@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
7884@kindex --no-toc-sort
7885@item --no-toc-sort
7886By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
7887happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
7888placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
7889with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
7890referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
7891@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
7892results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
7893off this feature.
7894
7895@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
7896@kindex --plt-align
7897@kindex --no-plt-align
7898@item --plt-align
7899@itemx --no-plt-align
7900Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
7901aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
7902boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
7903specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
7904specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
7905if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
7906PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
7907
7908@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
7909@kindex --plt-static-chain
7910@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
7911@item --plt-static-chain
7912@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
7913Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
7914chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
7915chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
7916
7917@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
7918@kindex --plt-thread-safe
7919@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
7920@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 7921@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
7922With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
7923lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
7924another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
7925order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
7926memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
7927barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
7928looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
7929seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
7930default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
7931
7932@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
7933@kindex --plt-localentry
7934@kindex --no-plt-localentry
7935@item --plt-localentry
7936@itemx --no-localentry
7937ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
7938ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
7939(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
7940Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
7941or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
7942functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
7943in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
7944interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
7945including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
7946to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
7947complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
7948care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
7949
7950@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
7951@kindex --power10-stubs
7952@kindex --no-power10-stubs
7953@item --power10-stubs
7954@itemx --no-power10-stubs
7955When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
7956relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
7957linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
7958for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
7959power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
7960power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
7961allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
7962@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
7963auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
7964@end table
7965
7966@ifclear GENERIC
7967@lowersections
7968@end ifclear
7969@end ifset
7970
b4cbbe8f
AK
7971@ifset S/390
7972@ifclear GENERIC
7973@raisesections
7974@end ifclear
7975
7976@node S/390 ELF
7977@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7978
7979@cindex S/390 ELF options
7980@table @option
7981
7982@cindex S/390
7983@kindex --s390-pgste
7984@item --s390-pgste
7985This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
7986segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
7987binaries marked that way.
7988@end table
7989
7990@ifclear GENERIC
7991@lowersections
7992@end ifclear
7993@end ifset
7994
49fa1e15
AM
7995@ifset SPU
7996@ifclear GENERIC
7997@raisesections
7998@end ifclear
7999
8000@node SPU ELF
8001@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8002
8003@cindex SPU ELF options
8004@table @option
8005
8006@cindex SPU plugins
8007@kindex --plugin
8008@item --plugin
8009This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8010
8011@cindex SPU overlays
8012@kindex --no-overlays
8013@item --no-overlays
8014Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8015regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8016@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8017turns off all this special overlay handling.
8018
8019@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8020@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8021@item --emit-stub-syms
8022This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8023symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8024
8025@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8026@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8027@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8028This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8029function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8030on calls to non-overlay regions.
8031
8032@cindex SPU local store size
8033@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8034@item --local-store=lo:hi
8035@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8036the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8037range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8038
c0065db7 8039@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8040@kindex --stack-analysis
8041@item --stack-analysis
8042SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8043unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8044under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8045@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8046@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8047determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8048for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8049for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8050for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8051find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8052and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8053under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8054dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8055is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8056and calls will be given.
8057
c0065db7 8058@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8059@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8060@item --emit-stack-syms
8061This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8062in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8063These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8064functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8065functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8066such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8067The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8068@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8069@end table
8070
8071@ifclear GENERIC
8072@lowersections
8073@end ifclear
8074@end ifset
8075
36f63dca
NC
8076@ifset TICOFF
8077@ifclear GENERIC
8078@raisesections
8079@end ifclear
8080
8081@node TI COFF
8082@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8083@cindex TI COFF versions
8084@kindex --format=@var{version}
8085The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8086TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8087also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8088format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8089header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8090
8091@ifclear GENERIC
8092@lowersections
8093@end ifclear
8094@end ifset
8095
2ca22b03
NC
8096@ifset WIN32
8097@ifclear GENERIC
8098@raisesections
8099@end ifclear
8100
8101@node WIN32
8102@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8103
c0065db7 8104This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8105See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8106command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8107
8108@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8109@cindex import libraries
8110@item import libraries
69da35b5 8111The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8112libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8113regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8114archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8115support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8116@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8117
c0065db7
RM
8118@item exporting DLL symbols
8119@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8120The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8121
8122@table @emph
8123@item using auto-export functionality
8124@cindex using auto-export functionality
8125By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8126which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8127
0a5d968e
NC
8128@itemize
8129@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8130@item --exclude-symbols
8131@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8132@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8133@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8134@end itemize
8135
09e2aba4
DK
8136When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8137(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8138symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8139often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8140private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8141options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8142exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8143final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8144
8145If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8146command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8147if either of the following are true:
8148
8149@itemize
8150@item A DEF file is used.
8151@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8152@end itemize
dc8465bf 8153
c0065db7
RM
8154@item using a DEF file
8155@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8156Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8157an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8158exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8159name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8160command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8161
8162@example
8163gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8164@end example
8165
0a5d968e
NC
8166Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8167@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8168
dc8465bf
NC
8169Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8170
8171@example
4b5bd4e7 8172LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8173
8174EXPORTS
8175foo
8176bar
8177_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8178another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8179var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8180doo = foo == foo2
8181eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8182@end example
dc8465bf 8183
7fcab871 8184This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8185symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8186alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8187by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8188@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8189@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8190export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8191in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8192symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8193
6b31ad16
DS
8194The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8195name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8196the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8197
b45619c0
NC
8198When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8199library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8200@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8201executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8202
8203With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8204specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8205non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8206
8207If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8208or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8209filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8210
4b5bd4e7
DS
8211The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8212
8213@example
8214EXPORTS
8215 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8216 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8217 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8218@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8219
8220Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8221@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8222@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8223@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8224Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8225@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8226string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8227
8228The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8229
8230@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8231will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8232by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8233linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8234library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8235
8236@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8237The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8238the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8239@code{*_imp__foo}).
8240
8241@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8242well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8243read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8244variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8245the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8246extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8247application will behave unexpectedly.
8248
8249@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8250it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8251symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8252API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8253the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8254
4b5bd4e7
DS
8255See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8256other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8257
8258@cindex creating a DEF file
8259While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8260with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8261
8262@item Using decorations
8263@cindex Using decorations
8264Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8265itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8266declared as:
8267
8268@example
8269__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8270__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8271@end example
8272
8273All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8274any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8275this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8276the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8277
8278Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8279decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8280instead:
8281
8282@example
8283__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8284__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8285@end example
8286
c0065db7
RM
8287This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8288when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8289variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8290code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8291of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8292omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8293@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8294information.
c0065db7 8295@end table
dc8465bf 8296
2ca22b03
NC
8297@cindex automatic data imports
8298@item automatic data imports
8299The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8300by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8301compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8302issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8303code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8304c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8305initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8306decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8307platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8308command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8309The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8310suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8311trigger the feature's use.
8312
c0065db7 8313auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8314additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8315
c0065db7 8316"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8317documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8318
c0065db7
RM
8319The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8320occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8321One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8322below.
8323
8324@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8325For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8326object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8327offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8328field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8329in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8330without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8331The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8332references.
8333
c0065db7
RM
8334The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8335be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8336themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8337runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8338compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8339support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8340run without error on an older system.
8341
c0065db7
RM
8342@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8343enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8344
8345@cindex direct linking to a dll
8346@item direct linking to a dll
8347The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8348including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8349libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8350traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8351libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8352function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8353though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8354storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8355tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8356large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8357
c0065db7 8358Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8359@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8360of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8361perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8362select the dll instead of an import library.
8363
2ca22b03 8364
69da35b5
NC
8365For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8366to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8367
8368@example
45e948fe
NC
8369libxxx.dll.a
8370xxx.dll.a
8371libxxx.a
8372xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8373libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8374cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8375libxxx.dll
8376xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8377@end example
8378
69da35b5
NC
8379before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8380
c0065db7
RM
8381(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8382where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8383@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8384file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8385@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8386
c0065db7
RM
8387Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8388@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8389was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8390various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8391could coexist on the same machine.
8392
2ca22b03
NC
8393The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8394applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8395libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8396
8397@example
8398bin/
8399 cygxxx.dll
8400lib/
8401 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8402 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8403@end example
8404
c0065db7
RM
8405Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8406done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8407
84081. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8409@example
8410gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8411@end example
2ca22b03 8412
69da35b5
NC
8413However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8414(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8415@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8416not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8417
2ca22b03
NC
84182. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8419directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8420should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8421making the app/dll.
8422
8423@example
8424ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8425@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8426
8427Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8428
8429@example
8430gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8431@end example
69da35b5
NC
8432
8433This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8434perfectly legal
8435
8436@example
8437bin/
8438 cygxxx-5.dll
8439lib/
c0065db7 8440 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8441@end example
8442
dc8465bf 8443Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8444even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8445@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8446
8447Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8448wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8449
84501. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8451work with auto-imported data.
8452
dc8465bf
NC
84532. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8454import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8455symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8456for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8457possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8458
45e948fe
NC
84593. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8460critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8461in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8462stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8463
69da35b5 8464So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8465true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8466a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8467binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8468massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8469requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8470will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8471
c0065db7 8472@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8473@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8474@item adding additional names
8475Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8476A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8477exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8478when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8479import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8480
c0065db7 8481@example
dc8465bf
NC
8482LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8483
8484EXPORTS
c0065db7 8485foo
dc8465bf 8486_foo = foo
c0065db7 8487@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8488
8489The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8490
8491Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8492source code using the "weak" attribute:
8493
c0065db7
RM
8494@example
8495void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8496void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8497@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8498
8499See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8500symbols.
8501
8502@item renaming symbols
8503Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8504kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8505@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8506DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8507created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8508
c0065db7 8509@example
dc8465bf
NC
8510LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8511
8512EXPORTS
8513_foo = foo
c0065db7 8514@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8515
8516The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8517@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8518@end table
dc8465bf 8519
0a5d968e 8520Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8521unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8522If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8523@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8524that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8525@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8526renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8527to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8528the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8529In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8530which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8531
8532@cindex weak externals
8533@item weak externals
8534The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8535weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8536defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8537are three variants of weak externals:
8538@itemize
8539@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8540called lazy externals.
8541@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8542This form is not presently implemented.
8543@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8544implemented.
8545@end itemize
8546As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8547are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8548uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8549
8550@cindex aligned common symbols
8551@item aligned common symbols
8552As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8553desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8554the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8555carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8556by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8557tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8558but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8559warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8560
2ca22b03
NC
8561@end table
8562
8563@ifclear GENERIC
8564@lowersections
8565@end ifclear
8566@end ifset
8567
e0001a05
NC
8568@ifset XTENSA
8569@ifclear GENERIC
8570@raisesections
8571@end ifclear
8572
8573@node Xtensa
8574@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8575
8576@cindex Xtensa processors
8577The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8578@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8579specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8580keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8581example, with the command:
8582
8583@smallexample
8584SECTIONS
8585@{
8586 .text : @{
8587 *(.literal .text)
8588 @}
8589@}
8590@end smallexample
8591
8592@noindent
8593@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8594and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8595literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8596interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8597group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8598files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8599and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8600
43cd72b9 8601@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8602@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8603Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8604provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8605is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8606literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8607will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8608location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8609the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8610unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8611@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8612range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8613
8614For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8615to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8616instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8617instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8618instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8619@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8620hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8621By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8622switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8623density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8624instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8625performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8626linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8627a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8628
8629The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8630control the linker:
8631
8632@cindex Xtensa options
8633@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
8634@item --size-opt
8635When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8636more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8637no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8638alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8639preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
8640
8641@item --abi-windowed
8642@itemx --abi-call0
8643Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8644PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8645because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8646conventions.
8647Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8648of the first input object.
8649A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8650or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 8651@end table
e0001a05
NC
8652
8653@ifclear GENERIC
8654@lowersections
8655@end ifclear
8656@end ifset
8657
252b5132
RH
8658@ifclear SingleFormat
8659@node BFD
8660@chapter BFD
8661
8662@cindex back end
8663@cindex object file management
8664@cindex object formats available
8665@kindex objdump -i
8666The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8667These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8668object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8669format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8670it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8671associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8672object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8673(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8674list all the formats available for your configuration.
8675
8676@cindex BFD requirements
8677@cindex requirements for BFD
8678As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8679several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8680BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8681formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8682been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8683BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8684may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8685
8686One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8687mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8688useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8689conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8690
8691@menu
8692* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8693@end menu
8694
8695@node BFD outline
36f63dca 8696@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
8697@cindex opening object files
8698@include bfdsumm.texi
8699@end ifclear
8700
8701@node Reporting Bugs
8702@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
8703@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8704@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 8705
ff5dcc92 8706Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
8707
8708Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8709it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 8710to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 8711work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 8712@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8713
8714In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8715information that enables us to fix the bug.
8716
8717@menu
8718* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8719* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8720@end menu
8721
8722@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 8723@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
8724@cindex bug criteria
8725
8726If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8727
8728@itemize @bullet
8729@cindex fatal signal
8730@cindex linker crash
8731@cindex crash of linker
8732@item
8733If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 8734@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
8735
8736@cindex error on valid input
8737@item
ff5dcc92 8738If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
8739
8740@cindex invalid input
8741@item
ff5dcc92 8742If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
8743may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8744object files are correct.
8745
8746@item
8747If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 8748improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
8749@end itemize
8750
8751@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 8752@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 8753@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 8754@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
8755
8756A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 8757products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
8758recommend you contact that organization first.
8759
8760You can find contact information for many support companies and
8761individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
8762distribution.
8763
ad22bfe8 8764@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 8765Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
8766@value{BUGURL}.
8767@end ifset
252b5132
RH
8768
8769The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
8770@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
8771fact or leave it out, state it!
8772
8773Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
8774problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
8775assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
8776matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
8777the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
8778location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
8779were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
8780into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
8781specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 8782and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
8783
8784Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
8785the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
8786on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
8787
8788Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
8789bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
8790respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
8791You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
8792
8793To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
8794
8795@itemize @bullet
8796@item
ff5dcc92 8797The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
8798the @samp{--version} argument.
8799
8800Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 8801the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8802
8803@item
ff5dcc92 8804Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
8805patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
8806
8807@item
8808The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
8809version number.
8810
8811@item
ff5dcc92 8812What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
8813``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
8814
8815@item
8816The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
8817observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
8818list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
8819sufficient.
8820
8821If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
8822and then we might not encounter the bug.
8823
8824@item
8825A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
8826bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
8827provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
8828bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
8829state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
8830requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
8831we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
8832attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
8833
8834If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
8835@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
8836object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
8837@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
8838how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
8839
8840@item
8841A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
8842incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
8843
ff5dcc92 8844Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
8845will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
8846not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
8847a chance to make a mistake.
8848
8849Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
8850say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 8851copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
8852C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
8853and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
8854fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
8855you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
8856any conclusion from our observations.
8857
8858@item
ff5dcc92 8859If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
8860diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
8861@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 8862If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
8863context, not by line number.
8864
8865The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
8866sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
8867@end itemize
8868
8869Here are some things that are not necessary:
8870
8871@itemize @bullet
8872@item
8873A description of the envelope of the bug.
8874
8875Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
8876which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
8877changes will not affect it.
8878
8879This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
8880will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
8881with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
8882We recommend that you save your time for something else.
8883
8884Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
8885of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
8886output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
8887less time, and so on.
8888
8889However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
8890report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
8891
8892@item
8893A patch for the bug.
8894
8895A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
8896the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
8897a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
8898to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
8899
ff5dcc92 8900Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
8901construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
8902through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
8903able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
8904fixed.
8905
8906And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
8907patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
8908help us to understand.
8909
8910@item
8911A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
8912
8913Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
8914things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
8915@end itemize
8916
8917@node MRI
8918@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
8919@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
8920To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
8921linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
8922alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
8923described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
8924simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 8925@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
8926linker commands; these commands are described here.
8927
8928In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
8929file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
8930features to make use of them.
8931
8932You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
8933@samp{-c} command-line option.
8934
8935Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
8936command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
8937blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 8938MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
8939issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
8940
8941Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
8942
8943You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
8944lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
8945The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
8946
8947@table @code
8948@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
8949@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
8950@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 8951Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
8952the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
8953@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
8954your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
8955script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
8956commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
8957input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
8958@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
8959
8960@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
8961@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
8962Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
8963in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
8964
8965@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
8966
8967@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
8968@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
8969Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
8970@var{expression} should be a power of two.
8971
8972@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
8973@item BASE @var{expression}
8974Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
8975absolute addresses) in the output file.
8976
8977@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
8978@item CHIP @var{expression}
8979@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
8980This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
8981
8982@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
8983@item END
8984This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
8985
8986@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
8987@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
8988Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 8989language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
8990
8991@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
8992@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
8993Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 8994@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
8995
8996The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
8997same line, with no change in its effect.
8998
8999@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9000@item LOAD @var{filename}
9001@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9002Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9003same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9004command line.
9005
9006@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9007@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9008@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9009MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9010option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9011
9012@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9013@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9014@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9015Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9016order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9017script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9018sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9019file, in the order specified.
9020
9021@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9022@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9023@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9024@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9025Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9026@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9027
9028@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9029@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9030@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9031@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9032You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9033specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9034If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9035@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9036@end table
9037
793c5807
NC
9038@node GNU Free Documentation License
9039@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9040@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9041
370b66a1
CD
9042@node LD Index
9043@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9044
9045@printindex cp
9046
9047@tex
7ca01ed9 9048% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9049% meantime:
9050\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9051\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9052\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9053\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9054\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9055\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9056\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9057\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9058\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9059% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9060@end tex
9061
252b5132 9062@bye